(auto-revert-handler): Print revert message before, rather than after,
[emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
blob2fadc156ff368fd042676e8c9301941220fce7e0
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2 Copyright (C) 1989, 93, 94, 95, 96, 97, 98, 1999, 2000, 01, 02, 2003
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
7 GNU Emacs is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option)
10 any later version.
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs; see the file COPYING. If not, write to
19 the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place - Suite 330,
20 Boston, MA 02111-1307, USA. */
22 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
23 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
25 #include <config.h>
27 /* On 4.3 these lose if they come after xterm.h. */
28 /* Putting these at the beginning seems to be standard for other .c files. */
29 #include <signal.h>
31 #include <stdio.h>
33 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
35 #include "lisp.h"
36 #include "blockinput.h"
38 /* Need syssignal.h for various externs and definitions that may be required
39 by some configurations for calls to signal later in this source file. */
40 #include "syssignal.h"
42 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
43 if this is not done before the other system files. */
44 #include "xterm.h"
45 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
47 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
48 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
49 #ifndef makedev
50 #include <sys/types.h>
51 #endif /* makedev */
53 #ifdef BSD_SYSTEM
54 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
55 #endif /* ! defined (BSD_SYSTEM) */
57 #include "systty.h"
58 #include "systime.h"
60 #ifndef INCLUDED_FCNTL
61 #include <fcntl.h>
62 #endif
63 #include <ctype.h>
64 #include <errno.h>
65 #include <setjmp.h>
66 #include <sys/stat.h>
67 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
68 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
70 #include "charset.h"
71 #include "coding.h"
72 #include "ccl.h"
73 #include "frame.h"
74 #include "dispextern.h"
75 #include "fontset.h"
76 #include "termhooks.h"
77 #include "termopts.h"
78 #include "termchar.h"
79 #include "gnu.h"
80 #include "disptab.h"
81 #include "buffer.h"
82 #include "window.h"
83 #include "keyboard.h"
84 #include "intervals.h"
85 #include "process.h"
86 #include "atimer.h"
87 #include "keymap.h"
89 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
90 #include <X11/Shell.h>
91 #endif
93 #ifdef HAVE_SYS_TIME_H
94 #include <sys/time.h>
95 #endif
96 #ifdef HAVE_UNISTD_H
97 #include <unistd.h>
98 #endif
100 #ifdef USE_GTK
101 #include "gtkutil.h"
102 #endif
104 #ifdef USE_LUCID
105 extern int xlwmenu_window_p P_ ((Widget w, Window window));
106 extern void xlwmenu_redisplay P_ ((Widget));
107 #endif
109 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
111 extern void free_frame_menubar P_ ((struct frame *));
112 extern struct frame *x_menubar_window_to_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
113 int));
114 #endif
116 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
117 #if (XtSpecificationRelease >= 5) && !defined(NO_EDITRES)
118 #define HACK_EDITRES
119 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages ();
120 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
122 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
124 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
125 #if defined USE_MOTIF
126 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
127 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
128 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
130 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
131 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
132 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
133 #define ARROW_SCROLLBAR
134 #define XAW_ARROW_SCROLLBARS
135 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ScrollbarP.h>
136 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
137 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
138 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
139 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
140 #ifndef XtNpickTop
141 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
142 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
143 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
144 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
146 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
148 #if ! defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) && ! defined (USE_GTK)
149 #define x_any_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
150 #define x_top_window_to_frame x_window_to_frame
151 #endif
153 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
154 #include "widget.h"
155 #ifndef XtNinitialState
156 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
157 #endif
158 #endif
160 #define abs(x) ((x) < 0 ? -(x) : (x))
162 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
163 #ifdef USE_XIM
164 int use_xim = 1;
165 #else
166 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
167 #endif
171 /* Non-nil means Emacs uses toolkit scroll bars. */
173 Lisp_Object Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars;
175 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
176 start. */
178 static int any_help_event_p;
180 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
181 static Lisp_Object last_window;
183 /* Non-zero means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties. */
185 int x_use_underline_position_properties;
187 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
188 use. */
190 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
192 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
193 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
194 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
195 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
197 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
199 /* Frame being updated by update_frame. This is declared in term.c.
200 This is set by update_begin and looked at by all the XT functions.
201 It is zero while not inside an update. In that case, the XT
202 functions assume that `selected_frame' is the frame to apply to. */
204 extern struct frame *updating_frame;
206 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
208 struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
210 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
211 /* The application context for Xt use. */
212 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
213 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
214 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
216 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
218 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
220 /* Mouse movement.
222 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
223 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
224 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
225 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
227 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
229 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
230 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
231 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
232 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
233 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
234 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
235 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
236 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
237 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
238 is off. */
240 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
242 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
243 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
245 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
247 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
248 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
249 an ordinary motion.
251 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
252 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
253 event. */
255 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
257 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
258 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
259 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
260 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
261 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
262 it's somewhat accurate. */
264 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
266 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
267 events. */
269 #ifdef __STDC__
270 static int volatile input_signal_count;
271 #else
272 static int input_signal_count;
273 #endif
275 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
277 static int x_noop_count;
279 /* Initial values of argv and argc. */
281 extern char **initial_argv;
282 extern int initial_argc;
284 extern Lisp_Object Vcommand_line_args, Vsystem_name;
286 /* Tells if a window manager is present or not. */
288 extern Lisp_Object Vx_no_window_manager;
290 extern Lisp_Object Qeql;
292 extern int errno;
294 /* A mask of extra modifier bits to put into every keyboard char. */
296 extern EMACS_INT extra_keyboard_modifiers;
298 /* The keysyms to use for the various modifiers. */
300 Lisp_Object Vx_alt_keysym, Vx_hyper_keysym, Vx_meta_keysym, Vx_super_keysym;
301 Lisp_Object Vx_keysym_table;
302 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
304 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
305 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
307 extern XrmDatabase x_load_resources P_ ((Display *, char *, char *, char *));
308 extern int x_bitmap_mask P_ ((FRAME_PTR, int));
310 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 P_ ((Display *, Colormap, XColor *));
311 static void x_set_window_size_1 P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
312 static const XColor *x_color_cells P_ ((Display *, int *));
313 static void x_update_window_end P_ ((struct window *, int, int));
314 void x_delete_display P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
315 static unsigned int x_x_to_emacs_modifiers P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
316 unsigned));
317 static int x_io_error_quitter P_ ((Display *));
318 int x_catch_errors P_ ((Display *));
319 void x_uncatch_errors P_ ((Display *, int));
320 void x_lower_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
321 void x_scroll_bar_clear P_ ((struct frame *));
322 int x_had_errors_p P_ ((Display *));
323 void x_wm_set_size_hint P_ ((struct frame *, long, int));
324 void x_raise_frame P_ ((struct frame *));
325 void x_set_window_size P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int));
326 void x_wm_set_window_state P_ ((struct frame *, int));
327 void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap P_ ((struct frame *, int));
328 void x_initialize P_ ((void));
329 static void x_font_min_bounds P_ ((XFontStruct *, int *, int *));
330 static int x_compute_min_glyph_bounds P_ ((struct frame *));
331 static void x_update_end P_ ((struct frame *));
332 static void XTframe_up_to_date P_ ((struct frame *));
333 static void XTset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
334 static void XTreset_terminal_modes P_ ((void));
335 static void x_clear_frame P_ ((void));
336 static void frame_highlight P_ ((struct frame *));
337 static void frame_unhighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
338 static void x_new_focus_frame P_ ((struct x_display_info *, struct frame *));
339 static void x_focus_changed P_ ((int, int, struct x_display_info *,
340 struct frame *, struct input_event *));
341 static void x_detect_focus_change P_ ((struct x_display_info *,
342 XEvent *, struct input_event *));
343 static void XTframe_rehighlight P_ ((struct frame *));
344 static void x_frame_rehighlight P_ ((struct x_display_info *));
345 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *));
346 static void x_draw_bar_cursor P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
347 enum text_cursor_kinds));
349 static void x_clip_to_row P_ ((struct window *, struct glyph_row *, GC));
350 static void x_flush P_ ((struct frame *f));
351 static void x_update_begin P_ ((struct frame *));
352 static void x_update_window_begin P_ ((struct window *));
353 static void x_after_update_window_line P_ ((struct glyph_row *));
354 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar P_ ((Display *, Window));
355 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion P_ ((struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
356 enum scroll_bar_part *,
357 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
358 unsigned long *));
359 static void x_check_fullscreen P_ ((struct frame *));
360 static void x_check_expected_move P_ ((struct frame *));
361 static int handle_one_xevent P_ ((struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
362 int *, struct input_event *));
365 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
367 static void
368 x_flush (f)
369 struct frame *f;
371 BLOCK_INPUT;
372 if (f == NULL)
374 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
375 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
376 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
378 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
379 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
380 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
384 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
385 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
386 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
387 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
388 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
389 performance. */
391 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
394 /***********************************************************************
395 Debugging
396 ***********************************************************************/
398 #if 0
400 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
401 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
403 struct record
405 char *locus;
406 int type;
409 struct record event_record[100];
411 int event_record_index;
413 record_event (locus, type)
414 char *locus;
415 int type;
417 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
418 event_record_index = 0;
420 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
421 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
422 event_record_index++;
425 #endif /* 0 */
429 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
431 struct x_display_info *
432 x_display_info_for_display (dpy)
433 Display *dpy;
435 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
437 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
438 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
439 return dpyinfo;
441 return 0;
446 /***********************************************************************
447 Starting and ending an update
448 ***********************************************************************/
450 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
451 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
452 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
453 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
454 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
456 static void
457 x_update_begin (f)
458 struct frame *f;
460 /* Nothing to do. */
464 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
465 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
466 position of W. */
468 static void
469 x_update_window_begin (w)
470 struct window *w;
472 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
473 struct x_display_info *display_info = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
475 updated_window = w;
476 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
478 BLOCK_INPUT;
480 if (f == display_info->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
482 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
483 display_info->mouse_face_defer = 1;
485 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
486 highlighting. */
487 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
488 display_info->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
490 #if 0 /* Rows in a current matrix containing glyphs in mouse-face have
491 their mouse_face_p flag set, which means that they are always
492 unequal to rows in a desired matrix which never have that
493 flag set. So, rows containing mouse-face glyphs are never
494 scrolled, and we don't have to switch the mouse highlight off
495 here to prevent it from being scrolled. */
497 /* Can we tell that this update does not affect the window
498 where the mouse highlight is? If so, no need to turn off.
499 Likewise, don't do anything if the frame is garbaged;
500 in that case, the frame's current matrix that we would use
501 is all wrong, and we will redisplay that line anyway. */
502 if (!NILP (display_info->mouse_face_window)
503 && w == XWINDOW (display_info->mouse_face_window))
505 int i;
507 for (i = 0; i < w->desired_matrix->nrows; ++i)
508 if (MATRIX_ROW_ENABLED_P (w->desired_matrix, i))
509 break;
511 if (i < w->desired_matrix->nrows)
512 clear_mouse_face (display_info);
514 #endif /* 0 */
517 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
521 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
523 static void
524 x_draw_vertical_window_border (w, x, y0, y1)
525 struct window *w;
526 int x, y0, y1;
528 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
530 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
531 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
534 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
536 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
537 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
539 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
540 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
541 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
543 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
544 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
545 here. */
547 static void
548 x_update_window_end (w, cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p)
549 struct window *w;
550 int cursor_on_p, mouse_face_overwritten_p;
552 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
554 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
556 BLOCK_INPUT;
558 if (cursor_on_p)
559 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
560 output_cursor.vpos,
561 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
563 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
565 draw_window_fringes (w);
567 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
570 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
571 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
572 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
574 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
575 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
576 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
579 updated_window = NULL;
583 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
584 update_end. */
586 static void
587 x_update_end (f)
588 struct frame *f;
590 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
591 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
593 #ifndef XFlush
594 BLOCK_INPUT;
595 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
596 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
597 #endif
601 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
602 complete update has been performed. The global variable
603 updated_window is not available here. */
605 static void
606 XTframe_up_to_date (f)
607 struct frame *f;
609 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
611 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
613 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
614 || f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
616 BLOCK_INPUT;
617 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
618 note_mouse_highlight (dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
619 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
620 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
621 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
622 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
628 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
629 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
630 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
631 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
632 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
633 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
635 static void
636 x_after_update_window_line (desired_row)
637 struct glyph_row *desired_row;
639 struct window *w = updated_window;
640 struct frame *f;
641 int width, height;
643 xassert (w);
645 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
646 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
648 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
649 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
650 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
651 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
652 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
653 overhead is very small. */
654 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
655 && desired_row->full_width_p
656 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
657 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
658 width != 0)
659 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
660 height > 0))
662 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
664 /* Internal border is drawn below the tool bar. */
665 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
666 && w == XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window))
667 y -= width;
669 BLOCK_INPUT;
670 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
671 0, y, width, height, False);
672 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
673 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
674 y, width, height, False);
675 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
679 static void
680 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (w, row, p)
681 struct window *w;
682 struct glyph_row *row;
683 struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p;
685 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
686 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
687 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
688 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
689 struct face *face = p->face;
690 int rowY;
692 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
693 rowY = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
694 if (p->y < rowY)
696 /* Adjust position of "bottom aligned" bitmap on partially
697 visible last row. */
698 int oldY = row->y;
699 int oldVH = row->visible_height;
700 row->visible_height = p->h;
701 row->y -= rowY - p->y;
702 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
703 row->y = oldY;
704 row->visible_height = oldVH;
706 else
707 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
709 if (p->bx >= 0 && !p->overlay_p)
711 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
712 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
713 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
714 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
715 if (face->stipple)
716 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
717 else
718 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
720 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc,
721 p->bx, p->by, p->nx, p->ny);
723 if (!face->stipple)
724 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
727 if (p->which)
729 unsigned char *bits;
730 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
731 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
732 XGCValues gcv;
734 if (p->wd > 8)
735 bits = (unsigned char *)(p->bits + p->dh);
736 else
737 bits = (unsigned char *)p->bits + p->dh;
739 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
740 by the server. */
741 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
742 (p->cursor_p
743 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
744 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
745 : face->foreground),
746 face->background, depth);
748 if (p->overlay_p)
750 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
751 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
752 bits, p->wd, p->h,
753 1, 0, 1);
754 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
755 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
756 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
757 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
760 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
761 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
762 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
764 if (p->overlay_p)
766 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
767 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
768 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
772 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
777 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
778 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
779 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
780 rarely happens). */
782 static void
783 XTset_terminal_modes ()
787 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
788 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
790 static void
791 XTreset_terminal_modes ()
797 /***********************************************************************
798 Display Iterator
799 ***********************************************************************/
801 /* Function prototypes of this page. */
803 static int x_encode_char P_ ((int, XChar2b *, struct font_info *, int *));
806 /* Get metrics of character CHAR2B in FONT. Value is null if CHAR2B
807 is not contained in the font. */
809 static XCharStruct *
810 x_per_char_metric (font, char2b, font_type)
811 XFontStruct *font;
812 XChar2b *char2b;
813 int font_type; /* unused on X */
815 /* The result metric information. */
816 XCharStruct *pcm = NULL;
818 xassert (font && char2b);
820 if (font->per_char != NULL)
822 if (font->min_byte1 == 0 && font->max_byte1 == 0)
824 /* min_char_or_byte2 specifies the linear character index
825 corresponding to the first element of the per_char array,
826 max_char_or_byte2 is the index of the last character. A
827 character with non-zero CHAR2B->byte1 is not in the font.
828 A character with byte2 less than min_char_or_byte2 or
829 greater max_char_or_byte2 is not in the font. */
830 if (char2b->byte1 == 0
831 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
832 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
833 pcm = font->per_char + char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2;
835 else
837 /* If either min_byte1 or max_byte1 are nonzero, both
838 min_char_or_byte2 and max_char_or_byte2 are less than
839 256, and the 2-byte character index values corresponding
840 to the per_char array element N (counting from 0) are:
842 byte1 = N/D + min_byte1
843 byte2 = N\D + min_char_or_byte2
845 where:
847 D = max_char_or_byte2 - min_char_or_byte2 + 1
848 / = integer division
849 \ = integer modulus */
850 if (char2b->byte1 >= font->min_byte1
851 && char2b->byte1 <= font->max_byte1
852 && char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
853 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
855 pcm = (font->per_char
856 + ((font->max_char_or_byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2 + 1)
857 * (char2b->byte1 - font->min_byte1))
858 + (char2b->byte2 - font->min_char_or_byte2));
862 else
864 /* If the per_char pointer is null, all glyphs between the first
865 and last character indexes inclusive have the same
866 information, as given by both min_bounds and max_bounds. */
867 if (char2b->byte2 >= font->min_char_or_byte2
868 && char2b->byte2 <= font->max_char_or_byte2)
869 pcm = &font->max_bounds;
872 return ((pcm == NULL
873 || (pcm->width == 0 && (pcm->rbearing - pcm->lbearing) == 0))
874 ? NULL : pcm);
878 /* Encode CHAR2B using encoding information from FONT_INFO. CHAR2B is
879 the two-byte form of C. Encoding is returned in *CHAR2B. */
881 static int
882 x_encode_char (c, char2b, font_info, two_byte_p)
883 int c;
884 XChar2b *char2b;
885 struct font_info *font_info;
886 int *two_byte_p;
888 int charset = CHAR_CHARSET (c);
889 XFontStruct *font = font_info->font;
891 /* FONT_INFO may define a scheme by which to encode byte1 and byte2.
892 This may be either a program in a special encoder language or a
893 fixed encoding. */
894 if (font_info->font_encoder)
896 /* It's a program. */
897 struct ccl_program *ccl = font_info->font_encoder;
899 if (CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 1)
901 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
902 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte2;
903 ccl->reg[2] = -1;
905 else
907 ccl->reg[0] = charset;
908 ccl->reg[1] = char2b->byte1;
909 ccl->reg[2] = char2b->byte2;
912 ccl_driver (ccl, NULL, NULL, 0, 0, NULL);
914 /* We assume that MSBs are appropriately set/reset by CCL
915 program. */
916 if (font->max_byte1 == 0) /* 1-byte font */
917 char2b->byte1 = 0, char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[1];
918 else
919 char2b->byte1 = ccl->reg[1], char2b->byte2 = ccl->reg[2];
921 else if (font_info->encoding[charset])
923 /* Fixed encoding scheme. See fontset.h for the meaning of the
924 encoding numbers. */
925 int enc = font_info->encoding[charset];
927 if ((enc == 1 || enc == 2)
928 && CHARSET_DIMENSION (charset) == 2)
929 char2b->byte1 |= 0x80;
931 if (enc == 1 || enc == 3)
932 char2b->byte2 |= 0x80;
935 if (two_byte_p)
936 *two_byte_p = ((XFontStruct *) (font_info->font))->max_byte1 > 0;
938 return FONT_TYPE_UNKNOWN;
943 /***********************************************************************
944 Glyph display
945 ***********************************************************************/
949 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
950 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
951 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background P_ ((struct glyph_string *,
952 int));
953 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
954 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
955 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
956 static void x_draw_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
957 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
958 static void x_set_cursor_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
959 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
960 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
961 static int x_alloc_lighter_color P_ ((struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
962 unsigned long *, double, int));
963 static void x_setup_relief_color P_ ((struct frame *, struct relief *,
964 double, int, unsigned long));
965 static void x_setup_relief_colors P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
966 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
967 static void x_draw_image_relief P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
968 static void x_draw_image_foreground P_ ((struct glyph_string *));
969 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 P_ ((struct glyph_string *, Pixmap));
970 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int,
971 int, int, int));
972 static void x_draw_relief_rect P_ ((struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
973 int, int, int, int, XRectangle *));
974 static void x_draw_box_rect P_ ((struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
975 int, int, int, XRectangle *));
977 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
978 static void x_check_font P_ ((struct frame *, XFontStruct *));
979 #endif
982 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
983 face. */
985 static void
986 x_set_cursor_gc (s)
987 struct glyph_string *s;
989 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
990 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
991 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
992 && !s->cmp)
993 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
994 else
996 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
997 XGCValues xgcv;
998 unsigned long mask;
1000 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
1001 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1003 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
1004 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1005 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1006 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1007 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
1008 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
1009 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1011 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
1012 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
1013 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
1015 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
1016 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
1019 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1020 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1021 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1022 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1024 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1025 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1026 mask, &xgcv);
1027 else
1028 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1029 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1031 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1036 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
1038 static void
1039 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s)
1040 struct glyph_string *s;
1042 int face_id;
1043 struct face *face;
1045 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
1046 face_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
1047 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1048 if (face == NULL)
1049 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
1051 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1052 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch);
1053 else
1054 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0);
1055 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
1056 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1058 /* If font in this face is same as S->font, use it. */
1059 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1060 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1061 else
1063 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1064 but font FONT. */
1065 XGCValues xgcv;
1066 unsigned long mask;
1068 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1069 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1070 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
1071 xgcv.font = s->font->fid;
1072 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1073 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCFont | GCGraphicsExposures;
1075 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1076 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1077 mask, &xgcv);
1078 else
1079 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1080 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1082 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1085 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1089 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1090 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1091 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1093 static INLINE void
1094 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s)
1095 struct glyph_string *s;
1097 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1101 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1102 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1103 pattern. */
1105 static INLINE void
1106 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s)
1107 struct glyph_string *s;
1109 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1111 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1113 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1114 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1116 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1118 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1119 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1121 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1123 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1124 s->stippled_p = 0;
1126 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1128 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1129 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1131 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1132 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1134 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1135 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1137 else
1139 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1140 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1143 /* GC must have been set. */
1144 xassert (s->gc != 0);
1148 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1149 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1151 static INLINE void
1152 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s)
1153 struct glyph_string *s;
1155 XRectangle r;
1156 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
1157 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1161 /* RIF:
1162 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. If S is a glyph
1163 string for a composition, assume overhangs don't exist. */
1165 static void
1166 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (s)
1167 struct glyph_string *s;
1169 if (s->cmp == NULL
1170 && s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1172 XCharStruct cs;
1173 int direction, font_ascent, font_descent;
1174 XTextExtents16 (s->font, s->char2b, s->nchars, &direction,
1175 &font_ascent, &font_descent, &cs);
1176 s->right_overhang = cs.rbearing > cs.width ? cs.rbearing - cs.width : 0;
1177 s->left_overhang = cs.lbearing < 0 ? -cs.lbearing : 0;
1182 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1184 static INLINE void
1185 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
1186 struct glyph_string *s;
1187 int x, y, w, h;
1189 XGCValues xgcv;
1190 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1191 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1192 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1193 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1197 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1198 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1199 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1200 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1201 contains the first component of a composition. */
1203 static void
1204 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, force_p)
1205 struct glyph_string *s;
1206 int force_p;
1208 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1209 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1210 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1212 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1214 if (s->stippled_p)
1216 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1217 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1218 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1219 s->y + box_line_width,
1220 s->background_width,
1221 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1222 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1223 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1225 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1226 || s->font_not_found_p
1227 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1228 || force_p)
1230 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1231 s->background_width,
1232 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1233 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1239 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1241 static void
1242 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1243 struct glyph_string *s;
1245 int i, x;
1247 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1248 of S to the right of that box line. */
1249 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1250 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1251 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1252 else
1253 x = s->x;
1255 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1256 loaded. */
1257 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1259 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1261 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1262 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1263 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1264 s->height - 1);
1265 x += g->pixel_width;
1268 else
1270 char *char1b = (char *) s->char2b;
1271 int boff = s->font_info->baseline_offset;
1273 if (s->font_info->vertical_centering)
1274 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (s->font, s->f) - boff;
1276 /* If we can use 8-bit functions, condense S->char2b. */
1277 if (!s->two_byte_p)
1278 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1279 char1b[i] = s->char2b[i].byte2;
1281 /* Draw text with XDrawString if background has already been
1282 filled. Otherwise, use XDrawImageString. (Note that
1283 XDrawImageString is usually faster than XDrawString.) Always
1284 use XDrawImageString when drawing the cursor so that there is
1285 no chance that characters under a box cursor are invisible. */
1286 if (s->for_overlaps_p
1287 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1289 /* Draw characters with 16-bit or 8-bit functions. */
1290 if (s->two_byte_p)
1291 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1292 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1293 else
1294 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1295 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1297 else
1299 if (s->two_byte_p)
1300 XDrawImageString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1301 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1302 else
1303 XDrawImageString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x,
1304 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1307 if (s->face->overstrike)
1309 /* For overstriking (to simulate bold-face), draw the
1310 characters again shifted to the right by one pixel. */
1311 if (s->two_byte_p)
1312 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1313 s->ybase - boff, s->char2b, s->nchars);
1314 else
1315 XDrawString (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x + 1,
1316 s->ybase - boff, char1b, s->nchars);
1321 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1323 static void
1324 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s)
1325 struct glyph_string *s;
1327 int i, x;
1329 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1330 of S to the right of that box line. */
1331 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1332 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1333 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
1334 else
1335 x = s->x;
1337 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->gidx is the index of
1338 the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1339 S->gidx == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1340 this composition. */
1342 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1343 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1344 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1346 if (s->gidx == 0)
1347 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1348 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1350 else
1352 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, ++s->gidx)
1354 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1355 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2],
1356 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1357 s->char2b + i, 1);
1358 if (s->face->overstrike)
1359 XDrawString16 (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1360 x + s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2] + 1,
1361 s->ybase - s->cmp->offsets[s->gidx * 2 + 1],
1362 s->char2b + i, 1);
1368 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1370 static struct frame *x_frame_of_widget P_ ((Widget));
1371 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel P_ ((Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1372 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *));
1373 static void cvt_pixel_dtor P_ ((XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1374 XrmValue *, Cardinal *));
1377 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1378 cannot be determined. */
1380 static struct frame *
1381 x_frame_of_widget (widget)
1382 Widget widget;
1384 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1385 Lisp_Object tail;
1386 struct frame *f;
1388 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1390 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1391 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1392 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1393 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1394 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1395 widget = XtParent (widget);
1397 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1398 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1399 for (tail = Vframe_list; GC_CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1400 if (GC_FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1401 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1402 (f->output_data.nothing != 1
1403 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1404 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1405 return f;
1407 abort ();
1411 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on the screen and display of
1412 widget WIDGET in colormap CMAP. If an exact match cannot be
1413 allocated, try the nearest color available. Value is non-zero
1414 if successful. This is called from lwlib. */
1417 x_alloc_nearest_color_for_widget (widget, cmap, color)
1418 Widget widget;
1419 Colormap cmap;
1420 XColor *color;
1422 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1423 return x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color);
1427 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1428 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1429 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1430 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1431 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1432 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1435 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (widget, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1436 Widget widget;
1437 Display *display;
1438 Colormap cmap;
1439 unsigned long *pixel;
1440 double factor;
1441 int delta;
1443 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1444 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1448 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1449 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1451 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1453 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1454 sizeof (Screen *)},
1455 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1456 sizeof (Colormap)}
1460 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1461 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1463 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1466 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1468 DPY is the display we are working on.
1470 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1471 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1472 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1473 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1475 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1476 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1478 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1479 we allocated the color or not.
1481 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1483 static Boolean
1484 cvt_string_to_pixel (dpy, args, nargs, from, to, closure_ret)
1485 Display *dpy;
1486 XrmValue *args;
1487 Cardinal *nargs;
1488 XrmValue *from, *to;
1489 XtPointer *closure_ret;
1491 Screen *screen;
1492 Colormap cmap;
1493 Pixel pixel;
1494 String color_name;
1495 XColor color;
1497 if (*nargs != 2)
1499 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1500 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1501 "XtToolkitError",
1502 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1503 return False;
1506 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1507 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1508 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1510 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1512 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1513 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1515 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1517 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1518 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1520 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1521 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1523 pixel = color.pixel;
1524 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1526 else
1528 String params[1];
1529 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1531 params[0] = color_name;
1532 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1533 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1534 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1535 params, &nparams);
1536 return False;
1539 if (to->addr != NULL)
1541 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1543 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1544 return False;
1547 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1549 else
1551 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1552 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1555 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1556 return True;
1560 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1561 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1562 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1564 APP is the application context in which we work.
1566 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1567 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1568 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1570 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1572 static void
1573 cvt_pixel_dtor (app, to, closure, args, nargs)
1574 XtAppContext app;
1575 XrmValuePtr to;
1576 XtPointer closure;
1577 XrmValuePtr args;
1578 Cardinal *nargs;
1580 if (*nargs != 2)
1582 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1583 "XtToolkitError",
1584 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1585 NULL, NULL);
1587 else if (closure != NULL)
1589 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1590 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1591 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1592 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1593 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1598 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1601 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1602 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1603 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1604 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1606 static const XColor *
1607 x_color_cells (dpy, ncells)
1608 Display *dpy;
1609 int *ncells;
1611 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1613 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1615 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1616 int i;
1618 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1619 = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1620 dpyinfo->color_cells
1621 = (XColor *) xmalloc (dpyinfo->ncolor_cells
1622 * sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1624 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells; ++i)
1625 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1627 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1628 dpyinfo->color_cells, dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1631 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1632 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1636 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1637 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1639 void
1640 x_query_colors (f, colors, ncolors)
1641 struct frame *f;
1642 XColor *colors;
1643 int ncolors;
1645 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1647 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1649 int i;
1650 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1652 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1653 xassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1654 xassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1655 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1658 else
1659 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1663 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1664 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1666 void
1667 x_query_color (f, color)
1668 struct frame *f;
1669 XColor *color;
1671 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1675 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1676 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1677 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1678 allocated. */
1680 static int
1681 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, color)
1682 Display *dpy;
1683 Colormap cmap;
1684 XColor *color;
1686 int rc;
1688 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1689 if (rc == 0)
1691 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1692 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1693 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1694 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1695 int nearest, i;
1696 unsigned long nearest_delta = ~0;
1697 int ncells;
1698 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1700 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1702 long dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1703 long dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1704 long dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1705 unsigned long delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1707 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1709 nearest = i;
1710 nearest_delta = delta;
1714 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1715 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1716 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1717 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1719 else
1721 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1722 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1723 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1724 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1725 XColor *cached_color;
1727 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1728 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1729 (cached_color->red != color->red
1730 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1731 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1733 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1734 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1735 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1739 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1740 if (rc)
1741 register_color (color->pixel);
1742 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1744 return rc;
1748 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1749 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1750 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1751 allocated. */
1754 x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, color)
1755 struct frame *f;
1756 Colormap cmap;
1757 XColor *color;
1759 gamma_correct (f, color);
1760 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1764 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1765 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1766 get color reference counts right. */
1768 unsigned long
1769 x_copy_color (f, pixel)
1770 struct frame *f;
1771 unsigned long pixel;
1773 XColor color;
1775 color.pixel = pixel;
1776 BLOCK_INPUT;
1777 x_query_color (f, &color);
1778 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1779 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1780 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1781 register_color (pixel);
1782 #endif
1783 return color.pixel;
1787 /* Allocate color PIXEL on display DPY. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1788 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1789 get color reference counts right. */
1791 unsigned long
1792 x_copy_dpy_color (dpy, cmap, pixel)
1793 Display *dpy;
1794 Colormap cmap;
1795 unsigned long pixel;
1797 XColor color;
1799 color.pixel = pixel;
1800 BLOCK_INPUT;
1801 XQueryColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1802 XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, &color);
1803 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1804 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1805 register_color (pixel);
1806 #endif
1807 return color.pixel;
1811 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1812 boosted.
1814 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1815 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1816 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1817 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1818 use an additional additive factor.
1820 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1821 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1822 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1825 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1826 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1827 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1828 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1829 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1830 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1832 static int
1833 x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta)
1834 struct frame *f;
1835 Display *display;
1836 Colormap cmap;
1837 unsigned long *pixel;
1838 double factor;
1839 int delta;
1841 XColor color, new;
1842 long bright;
1843 int success_p;
1845 /* Get RGB color values. */
1846 color.pixel = *pixel;
1847 x_query_color (f, &color);
1849 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1850 xassert (factor >= 0);
1851 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1852 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1853 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1855 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1856 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1858 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1859 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1860 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1861 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1862 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1864 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1865 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1866 /* The additive adjustment. */
1867 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1869 if (factor < 1)
1871 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1872 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1873 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1875 else
1877 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1878 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1879 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1883 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1884 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1885 if (success_p)
1887 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1889 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1890 delta to the RGB values. */
1891 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1893 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1894 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1895 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1896 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1898 else
1899 success_p = 1;
1900 *pixel = new.pixel;
1903 return success_p;
1907 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1908 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1909 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1910 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1911 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1912 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1914 static void
1915 x_setup_relief_color (f, relief, factor, delta, default_pixel)
1916 struct frame *f;
1917 struct relief *relief;
1918 double factor;
1919 int delta;
1920 unsigned long default_pixel;
1922 XGCValues xgcv;
1923 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1924 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1925 unsigned long pixel;
1926 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1927 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1928 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1929 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1931 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1932 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1934 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1935 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1936 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1937 if (relief->gc
1938 && relief->allocated_p)
1940 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1941 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1944 /* Allocate new color. */
1945 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1946 pixel = background;
1947 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1948 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1950 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1951 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1954 if (relief->gc == 0)
1956 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1957 mask |= GCStipple;
1958 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1960 else
1961 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1965 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1967 static void
1968 x_setup_relief_colors (s)
1969 struct glyph_string *s;
1971 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1972 unsigned long color;
1974 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1975 color = s->face->box_color;
1976 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1977 && s->img->pixmap
1978 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1979 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1980 else
1982 XGCValues xgcv;
1984 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1985 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1986 color = xgcv.background;
1989 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1990 || color != di->relief_background)
1992 di->relief_background = color;
1993 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1994 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1995 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1996 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
2001 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
2002 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
2003 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
2004 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
2005 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
2006 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
2007 when drawing. */
2009 static void
2010 x_draw_relief_rect (f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2011 raised_p, left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2012 struct frame *f;
2013 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p, raised_p;
2014 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2016 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
2017 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
2018 int i;
2019 GC gc;
2021 if (raised_p)
2022 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2023 else
2024 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2025 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2027 /* Top. */
2028 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2029 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2030 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2031 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2033 /* Left. */
2034 if (left_p)
2035 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2036 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2037 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2039 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2040 if (raised_p)
2041 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2042 else
2043 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2044 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2046 /* Bottom. */
2047 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2048 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2049 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2050 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2052 /* Right. */
2053 if (right_p)
2054 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2055 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2056 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2058 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2062 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2063 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2064 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2065 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2066 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2067 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2069 static void
2070 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2071 left_p, right_p, clip_rect)
2072 struct glyph_string *s;
2073 int left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width, left_p, right_p;
2074 XRectangle *clip_rect;
2076 XGCValues xgcv;
2078 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2079 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2080 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2082 /* Top. */
2083 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2084 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2086 /* Left. */
2087 if (left_p)
2088 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2089 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2091 /* Bottom. */
2092 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2093 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2095 /* Right. */
2096 if (right_p)
2097 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2098 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2100 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2101 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2105 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2107 static void
2108 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s)
2109 struct glyph_string *s;
2111 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2112 int left_p, right_p;
2113 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2114 XRectangle clip_rect;
2116 last_x = window_box_right (s->w, s->area);
2117 if (s->row->full_width_p
2118 && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2120 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_WIDTH (s->w);
2121 if (s->area != RIGHT_MARGIN_AREA
2122 || WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (s->w))
2123 last_x += WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (s->w);
2126 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2127 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2128 ? s->first_glyph
2129 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2131 width = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2132 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2133 left_x = s->x;
2134 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2135 ? last_x - 1
2136 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2137 top_y = s->y;
2138 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2140 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2141 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2142 && (s->prev == NULL
2143 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2144 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2145 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2146 && (s->next == NULL
2147 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2149 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2151 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2152 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2153 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2154 else
2156 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2157 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2158 width, raised_p, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2163 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2165 static void
2166 x_draw_image_foreground (s)
2167 struct glyph_string *s;
2169 int x;
2170 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2172 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2173 right of that line. */
2174 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2175 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2176 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2177 else
2178 x = s->x;
2180 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2181 by that margin. */
2182 x += s->img->hmargin;
2183 y += s->img->vmargin;
2185 if (s->img->pixmap)
2187 if (s->img->mask)
2189 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2190 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2191 trust on the shape extension to be available
2192 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2193 manually. */
2194 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2195 | GCFunction);
2196 XGCValues xgcv;
2197 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2199 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2200 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2201 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2202 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2203 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2205 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2206 image_rect.x = x;
2207 image_rect.y = y;
2208 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
2209 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
2210 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2211 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2212 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2214 else
2216 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2218 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2219 image_rect.x = x;
2220 image_rect.y = y;
2221 image_rect.width = s->img->width;
2222 image_rect.height = s->img->height;
2223 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2224 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2225 r.x - x, r.y - y, r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2227 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2228 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2229 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2230 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2231 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2232 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2233 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2235 int r = s->img->relief;
2236 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2237 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2238 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
2242 else
2243 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2244 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2245 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
2249 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2251 static void
2252 x_draw_image_relief (s)
2253 struct glyph_string *s;
2255 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2256 XRectangle r;
2257 int x;
2258 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2260 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2261 right of that line. */
2262 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2263 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2264 x = s->x + abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2265 else
2266 x = s->x;
2268 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2269 by that margin. */
2270 x += s->img->hmargin;
2271 y += s->img->vmargin;
2273 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2274 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2276 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2277 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2279 else
2281 thick = abs (s->img->relief);
2282 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2285 x0 = x - thick;
2286 y0 = y - thick;
2287 x1 = x + s->img->width + thick - 1;
2288 y1 = y + s->img->height + thick - 1;
2290 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2291 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2292 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p, 1, 1, &r);
2296 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2298 static void
2299 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap)
2300 struct glyph_string *s;
2301 Pixmap pixmap;
2303 int x;
2304 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face);
2306 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2307 right of that line. */
2308 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2309 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2310 x = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2311 else
2312 x = 0;
2314 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2315 by that margin. */
2316 x += s->img->hmargin;
2317 y += s->img->vmargin;
2319 if (s->img->pixmap)
2321 if (s->img->mask)
2323 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2324 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2325 trust on the shape extension to be available
2326 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2327 manually. */
2328 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2329 | GCFunction);
2330 XGCValues xgcv;
2332 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2333 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2334 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2335 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2336 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2338 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2339 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
2340 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2342 else
2344 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2345 0, 0, s->img->width, s->img->height, x, y);
2347 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2348 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2349 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2350 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2351 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2352 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2353 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2355 int r = s->img->relief;
2356 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2357 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2358 s->img->width + r*2 - 1, s->img->height + r*2 - 1);
2362 else
2363 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2364 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2365 s->img->width - 1, s->img->height - 1);
2369 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2370 give the rectangle to draw. */
2372 static void
2373 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, w, h)
2374 struct glyph_string *s;
2375 int x, y, w, h;
2377 if (s->stippled_p)
2379 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2380 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2381 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2382 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2384 else
2385 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2389 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2391 s->y
2392 s->x +-------------------------
2393 | s->face->box
2395 | +-------------------------
2396 | | s->img->margin
2398 | | +-------------------
2399 | | | the image
2403 static void
2404 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s)
2405 struct glyph_string *s;
2407 int x, y;
2408 int box_line_hwidth = abs (s->face->box_line_width);
2409 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2410 int height;
2411 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2413 height = s->height - 2 * box_line_vwidth;
2416 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2417 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2418 flickering. */
2419 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2420 if (height > s->img->height
2421 || s->img->hmargin
2422 || s->img->vmargin
2423 || s->img->mask
2424 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2425 || s->width != s->background_width)
2427 if (box_line_hwidth && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
2428 x = s->x + box_line_hwidth;
2429 else
2430 x = s->x;
2432 y = s->y + box_line_vwidth;
2434 if (s->img->mask)
2436 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2437 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2438 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2439 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2440 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2442 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2443 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2444 s->background_width,
2445 s->height, depth);
2447 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2448 pixmap. */
2449 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2451 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2452 if (s->stippled_p)
2454 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2455 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2456 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2457 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2458 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2460 else
2462 XGCValues xgcv;
2463 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2464 &xgcv);
2465 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2466 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2467 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2468 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2471 else
2472 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2474 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2477 /* Draw the foreground. */
2478 if (pixmap != None)
2480 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2481 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2482 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2483 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2484 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2486 else
2487 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2489 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2490 if (s->img->relief
2491 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2492 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2493 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2497 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2499 static void
2500 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s)
2501 struct glyph_string *s;
2503 xassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2504 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2506 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2507 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2509 /* If `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor
2510 as wide as the stretch glyph. */
2511 int width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), s->background_width);
2513 /* Draw cursor. */
2514 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, width, s->height);
2516 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2517 if (width < s->background_width)
2519 int x = s->x + width, y = s->y;
2520 int w = s->background_width - width, h = s->height;
2521 XRectangle r;
2522 GC gc;
2524 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2525 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2527 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2528 gc = s->gc;
2530 else
2531 gc = s->face->gc;
2533 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2534 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2536 if (s->face->stipple)
2538 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2539 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2540 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2541 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2543 else
2545 XGCValues xgcv;
2546 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2547 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2548 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2549 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2553 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2554 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, s->x, s->y, s->background_width,
2555 s->height);
2557 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2561 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2563 static void
2564 x_draw_glyph_string (s)
2565 struct glyph_string *s;
2567 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2569 /* If S draws into the background of its successor, draw the
2570 background of the successor first so that S can draw into it.
2571 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2572 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps_p)
2574 xassert (s->next->img == NULL);
2575 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s->next);
2576 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s->next);
2577 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s->next, 1);
2580 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2581 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2583 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2584 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2585 if (!s->for_overlaps_p
2586 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2587 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2588 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2591 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2592 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2593 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2594 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2595 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2597 else
2598 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2600 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2602 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2603 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2604 break;
2606 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2607 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2608 break;
2610 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2611 if (s->for_overlaps_p)
2612 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2613 else
2614 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2615 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2616 break;
2618 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2619 if (s->for_overlaps_p || s->gidx > 0)
2620 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2621 else
2622 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2623 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2624 break;
2626 default:
2627 abort ();
2630 if (!s->for_overlaps_p)
2632 /* Draw underline. */
2633 if (s->face->underline_p)
2635 unsigned long tem, h;
2636 int y;
2638 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2639 if (!XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_THICKNESS, &h))
2640 h = 1;
2642 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2643 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2644 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2645 specs, and its default is
2647 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2648 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2650 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2651 && XGetFontProperty (s->font, XA_UNDERLINE_POSITION, &tem))
2652 y = s->ybase + (long) tem;
2653 else if (s->face->font)
2654 y = s->ybase + (s->face->font->max_bounds.descent + 1) / 2;
2655 else
2656 y = s->y + s->height - h;
2658 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2659 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2660 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2661 else
2663 XGCValues xgcv;
2664 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2665 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2666 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2667 s->x, y, s->width, h);
2668 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2672 /* Draw overline. */
2673 if (s->face->overline_p)
2675 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2677 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2678 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2679 s->width, h);
2680 else
2682 XGCValues xgcv;
2683 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2684 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2685 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2686 s->width, h);
2687 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2691 /* Draw strike-through. */
2692 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2694 unsigned long h = 1;
2695 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2697 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2698 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2699 s->width, h);
2700 else
2702 XGCValues xgcv;
2703 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2704 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2705 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2706 s->width, h);
2707 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2711 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2712 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2713 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2716 /* Reset clipping. */
2717 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2720 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2722 void
2723 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (f, x, y, width, height, shift_by)
2724 struct frame *f;
2725 int x, y, width, height, shift_by;
2727 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2728 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2729 x, y, width, height,
2730 x + shift_by, y);
2733 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
2734 for X frames. */
2736 static void
2737 x_delete_glyphs (n)
2738 register int n;
2740 abort ();
2744 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
2745 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
2747 void
2748 x_clear_area (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures)
2749 Display *dpy;
2750 Window window;
2751 int x, y;
2752 int width, height;
2753 int exposures;
2755 xassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
2756 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
2760 /* Clear entire frame. If updating_frame is non-null, clear that
2761 frame. Otherwise clear the selected frame. */
2763 static void
2764 x_clear_frame ()
2766 struct frame *f;
2768 if (updating_frame)
2769 f = updating_frame;
2770 else
2771 f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2773 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
2774 longer visible. */
2775 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
2776 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
2777 output_cursor.x = -1;
2779 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
2780 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
2781 BLOCK_INPUT;
2782 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
2784 /* We have to clear the scroll bars, too. If we have changed
2785 colors or something like that, then they should be notified. */
2786 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
2788 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2790 #ifdef USE_GTK
2791 xg_frame_cleared (f);
2792 #endif
2794 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2799 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
2801 /* We use the select system call to do the waiting, so we have to make
2802 sure it's available. If it isn't, we just won't do visual bells. */
2804 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2807 /* Subtract the `struct timeval' values X and Y, storing the result in
2808 *RESULT. Return 1 if the difference is negative, otherwise 0. */
2810 static int
2811 timeval_subtract (result, x, y)
2812 struct timeval *result, x, y;
2814 /* Perform the carry for the later subtraction by updating y. This
2815 is safer because on some systems the tv_sec member is unsigned. */
2816 if (x.tv_usec < y.tv_usec)
2818 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000 + 1;
2819 y.tv_usec -= 1000000 * nsec;
2820 y.tv_sec += nsec;
2823 if (x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec > 1000000)
2825 int nsec = (y.tv_usec - x.tv_usec) / 1000000;
2826 y.tv_usec += 1000000 * nsec;
2827 y.tv_sec -= nsec;
2830 /* Compute the time remaining to wait. tv_usec is certainly
2831 positive. */
2832 result->tv_sec = x.tv_sec - y.tv_sec;
2833 result->tv_usec = x.tv_usec - y.tv_usec;
2835 /* Return indication of whether the result should be considered
2836 negative. */
2837 return x.tv_sec < y.tv_sec;
2840 void
2841 XTflash (f)
2842 struct frame *f;
2844 BLOCK_INPUT;
2847 GC gc;
2849 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
2850 pixels into background pixels. */
2852 XGCValues values;
2854 values.function = GXxor;
2855 values.foreground = (f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel
2856 ^ f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
2858 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2859 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
2863 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
2864 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
2865 /* Height of each line to flash. */
2866 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
2867 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
2868 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2869 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
2871 int width;
2873 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
2874 edge it is next to. */
2875 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
2877 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
2878 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2879 break;
2881 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
2882 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
2883 break;
2885 default:
2886 break;
2889 width = flash_right - flash_left;
2891 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2892 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2894 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2895 flash_left,
2896 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2897 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2898 width, flash_height);
2899 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2900 flash_left,
2901 (height - flash_height
2902 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2903 width, flash_height);
2905 else
2906 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2907 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2908 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2909 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2911 x_flush (f);
2914 struct timeval wakeup;
2916 EMACS_GET_TIME (wakeup);
2918 /* Compute time to wait until, propagating carry from usecs. */
2919 wakeup.tv_usec += 150000;
2920 wakeup.tv_sec += (wakeup.tv_usec / 1000000);
2921 wakeup.tv_usec %= 1000000;
2923 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
2924 available. */
2925 while (! detect_input_pending ())
2927 struct timeval current;
2928 struct timeval timeout;
2930 EMACS_GET_TIME (current);
2932 /* Break if result would be negative. */
2933 if (timeval_subtract (&current, wakeup, current))
2934 break;
2936 /* How long `select' should wait. */
2937 timeout.tv_sec = 0;
2938 timeout.tv_usec = 10000;
2940 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
2941 select (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout);
2945 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
2946 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
2948 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2949 flash_left,
2950 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
2951 + FRAME_TOOL_BAR_LINES (f) * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f)),
2952 width, flash_height);
2953 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2954 flash_left,
2955 (height - flash_height
2956 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
2957 width, flash_height);
2959 else
2960 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
2961 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
2962 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
2963 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
2965 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
2966 x_flush (f);
2970 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
2973 #endif /* defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT) */
2976 /* Make audible bell. */
2978 void
2979 XTring_bell ()
2981 struct frame *f = SELECTED_FRAME ();
2983 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
2985 #if defined (HAVE_TIMEVAL) && defined (HAVE_SELECT)
2986 if (visible_bell)
2987 XTflash (f);
2988 else
2989 #endif
2991 BLOCK_INPUT;
2992 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
2993 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
2994 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3000 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3001 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3002 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3003 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3005 static void
3006 XTset_terminal_window (n)
3007 register int n;
3009 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3014 /***********************************************************************
3015 Line Dance
3016 ***********************************************************************/
3018 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3019 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3021 static void
3022 x_ins_del_lines (vpos, n)
3023 int vpos, n;
3025 abort ();
3029 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3031 static void
3032 x_scroll_run (w, run)
3033 struct window *w;
3034 struct run *run;
3036 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3037 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3039 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3040 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3041 fringe of W. */
3042 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3044 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3045 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3046 bottom_y = y + height;
3048 if (to_y < from_y)
3050 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3051 line at the bottom. */
3052 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3053 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3054 else
3055 height = run->height;
3057 else
3059 /* Scolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3060 at the bottom. */
3061 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3062 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3063 else
3064 height = run->height;
3067 BLOCK_INPUT;
3069 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3070 updated_window = w;
3071 x_clear_cursor (w);
3073 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3074 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3075 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3076 x, from_y,
3077 width, height,
3078 x, to_y);
3080 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3085 /***********************************************************************
3086 Exposure Events
3087 ***********************************************************************/
3090 static void
3091 frame_highlight (f)
3092 struct frame *f;
3094 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3095 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3096 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3097 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3098 BLOCK_INPUT;
3099 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3100 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3101 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3102 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3105 static void
3106 frame_unhighlight (f)
3107 struct frame *f;
3109 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3110 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3111 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3112 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3113 BLOCK_INPUT;
3114 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3115 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3116 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3117 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3120 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3121 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3122 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3123 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3124 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3126 static void
3127 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame)
3128 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3129 struct frame *frame;
3131 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3133 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3135 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3136 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3137 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3139 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3140 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3142 #if 0
3143 selected_frame = frame;
3144 XSETFRAME (XWINDOW (selected_frame->selected_window)->frame,
3145 selected_frame);
3146 Fselect_window (selected_frame->selected_window, Qnil);
3147 choose_minibuf_frame ();
3148 #endif /* ! 0 */
3150 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3151 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3152 else
3153 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3156 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3159 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3160 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3161 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3163 static void
3164 x_focus_changed (type, state, dpyinfo, frame, bufp)
3165 int type;
3166 int state;
3167 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3168 struct frame *frame;
3169 struct input_event *bufp;
3171 if (type == FocusIn)
3173 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3175 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3176 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3178 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3179 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3180 if (GC_NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3181 && GC_CONSP (Vframe_list)
3182 && !GC_NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3184 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3185 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3189 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3191 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3192 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3193 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3194 #endif
3196 else if (type == FocusOut)
3198 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3200 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3202 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3203 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3206 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3207 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3208 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3209 #endif
3213 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3214 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3216 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3218 static void
3219 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, event, bufp)
3220 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3221 XEvent *event;
3222 struct input_event *bufp;
3224 struct frame *frame;
3225 int nr_events = 0;
3227 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3228 if (! frame)
3229 return;
3231 switch (event->type)
3233 case EnterNotify:
3234 case LeaveNotify:
3236 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3237 int focus_state
3238 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3240 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3241 && event->xcrossing.focus
3242 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3243 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3244 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3245 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3247 break;
3249 case FocusIn:
3250 case FocusOut:
3251 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3252 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3253 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3254 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3255 break;
3260 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3262 void
3263 x_mouse_leave (dpyinfo)
3264 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3266 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3269 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3270 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3271 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3273 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3274 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3275 the appropriate X display info. */
3277 static void
3278 XTframe_rehighlight (frame)
3279 struct frame *frame;
3281 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3284 static void
3285 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo)
3286 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3288 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3290 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3292 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3293 = ((GC_FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3294 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3295 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3296 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3298 FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame) = Qnil;
3299 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3302 else
3303 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3305 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3307 if (old_highlight)
3308 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3309 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3310 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3316 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3318 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3319 static void
3320 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo)
3321 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3323 int min_code, max_code;
3324 KeySym *syms;
3325 int syms_per_code;
3326 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3328 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3329 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3330 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3331 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3332 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3334 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
3335 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3336 #else
3337 min_code = dpyinfo->display->min_keycode;
3338 max_code = dpyinfo->display->max_keycode;
3339 #endif
3341 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3342 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3343 &syms_per_code);
3344 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3346 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3347 Alt keysyms are on. */
3349 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3351 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3352 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3354 KeyCode code
3355 = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3357 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3358 if (code == 0)
3359 continue;
3361 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3363 int code_col;
3365 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3367 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3369 switch (sym)
3371 case XK_Meta_L:
3372 case XK_Meta_R:
3373 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3374 break;
3376 case XK_Alt_L:
3377 case XK_Alt_R:
3378 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3379 break;
3381 case XK_Hyper_L:
3382 case XK_Hyper_R:
3383 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3384 break;
3386 case XK_Super_L:
3387 case XK_Super_R:
3388 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3389 break;
3391 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3392 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3393 if ((1 << row) == LockMask)
3394 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3395 break;
3402 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3403 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3405 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3406 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3409 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3410 make them just meta, not alt. */
3411 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3413 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3416 XFree ((char *) syms);
3417 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3420 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3421 Emacs uses. */
3423 static unsigned int
3424 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3425 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3426 unsigned int state;
3428 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3429 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3430 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3431 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3432 Lisp_Object tem;
3434 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3435 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3436 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3437 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3438 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3439 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3440 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3441 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3444 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3445 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3446 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3447 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3448 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3449 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3452 static unsigned int
3453 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (dpyinfo, state)
3454 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
3455 unsigned int state;
3457 EMACS_UINT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3458 EMACS_UINT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3459 EMACS_UINT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3460 EMACS_UINT mod_super = super_modifier;
3462 Lisp_Object tem;
3464 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3465 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_alt = XUINT (tem);
3466 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3467 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_meta = XUINT (tem);
3468 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3469 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_hyper = XUINT (tem);
3470 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3471 if (! EQ (tem, Qnil)) mod_super = XUINT (tem);
3474 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3475 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3476 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3477 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3478 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3479 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3482 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3484 char *
3485 x_get_keysym_name (keysym)
3486 KeySym keysym;
3488 char *value;
3490 BLOCK_INPUT;
3491 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3492 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3494 return value;
3499 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3501 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3503 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3504 the mouse. */
3506 static Lisp_Object
3507 construct_mouse_click (result, event, f)
3508 struct input_event *result;
3509 XButtonEvent *event;
3510 struct frame *f;
3512 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3513 otherwise. */
3514 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3515 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3516 result->timestamp = event->time;
3517 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3518 event->state)
3519 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3520 ? up_modifier
3521 : down_modifier));
3523 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3524 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3525 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3526 result->arg = Qnil;
3527 return Qnil;
3531 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3532 The input handler calls this.
3534 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3535 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3536 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3537 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3539 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3540 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3542 static void
3543 note_mouse_movement (frame, event)
3544 FRAME_PTR frame;
3545 XMotionEvent *event;
3547 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3548 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3549 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3551 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3553 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3554 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3555 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3558 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3559 else if (event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3560 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3561 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3562 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3564 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3565 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3566 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3571 /************************************************************************
3572 Mouse Face
3573 ************************************************************************/
3575 static void
3576 redo_mouse_highlight ()
3578 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3579 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3580 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3581 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3582 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3586 static int glyph_rect P_ ((struct frame *f, int, int, XRectangle *));
3589 /* Try to determine frame pixel position and size of the glyph under
3590 frame pixel coordinates X/Y on frame F . Return the position and
3591 size in *RECT. Value is non-zero if we could compute these
3592 values. */
3594 static int
3595 glyph_rect (f, x, y, rect)
3596 struct frame *f;
3597 int x, y;
3598 XRectangle *rect;
3600 Lisp_Object window;
3601 struct window *w;
3602 struct glyph_row *r, *end_row;
3604 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, &x, &y, 0);
3605 if (NILP (window))
3606 return 0;
3608 w = XWINDOW (window);
3609 r = MATRIX_FIRST_TEXT_ROW (w->current_matrix);
3610 end_row = r + w->current_matrix->nrows - 1;
3612 for (; r < end_row && r->enabled_p; ++r)
3614 if (r->y >= y)
3616 struct glyph *g = r->glyphs[TEXT_AREA];
3617 struct glyph *end = g + r->used[TEXT_AREA];
3618 int gx = r->x;
3619 while (g < end && gx < x)
3620 gx += g->pixel_width, ++g;
3621 if (g < end)
3623 rect->width = g->pixel_width;
3624 rect->height = r->height;
3625 rect->x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, gx);
3626 rect->y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, r->y);
3627 return 1;
3629 break;
3633 return 0;
3637 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3638 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3640 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3641 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3642 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3643 position on the scroll bar.
3645 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3646 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3647 the mouse is over.
3649 Set *TIME to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3650 was at this position.
3652 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3654 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3655 movement. */
3657 static void
3658 XTmouse_position (fp, insist, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
3659 FRAME_PTR *fp;
3660 int insist;
3661 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
3662 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
3663 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
3664 unsigned long *time;
3666 FRAME_PTR f1;
3668 BLOCK_INPUT;
3670 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3671 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time);
3672 else
3674 Window root;
3675 int root_x, root_y;
3677 Window dummy_window;
3678 int dummy;
3680 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3682 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3683 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3684 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3685 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3687 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3689 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3690 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3691 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3693 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3694 &root,
3696 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3697 a different screen. */
3698 &dummy_window,
3700 /* The position on that root window. */
3701 &root_x, &root_y,
3703 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3704 &dummy, &dummy,
3706 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3707 we don't care. */
3708 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3710 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3711 containing the pointer. */
3713 Window win, child;
3714 int win_x, win_y;
3715 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3716 int count;
3718 win = root;
3720 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3721 structure is changing at the same time this function
3722 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3724 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3726 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3727 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3729 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3730 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3731 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3733 /* From-window, to-window. */
3734 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3736 /* From-position, to-position. */
3737 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3739 /* Child of win. */
3740 &child);
3741 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3743 else
3745 while (1)
3747 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3749 /* From-window, to-window. */
3750 root, win,
3752 /* From-position, to-position. */
3753 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3755 /* Child of win. */
3756 &child);
3758 if (child == None || child == win)
3759 break;
3761 win = child;
3762 parent_x = win_x;
3763 parent_y = win_y;
3766 /* Now we know that:
3767 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
3768 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
3769 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
3770 (XTC did this the last time through), and
3771 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
3772 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
3773 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
3774 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
3775 never use them in that case.) */
3777 /* Is win one of our frames? */
3778 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
3780 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
3781 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
3782 on the frame. */
3783 if (f1 != NULL
3784 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
3785 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
3786 f1 = NULL;
3787 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
3790 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
3791 f1 = 0;
3793 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), count);
3795 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
3796 if (! f1)
3798 struct scroll_bar *bar;
3800 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
3802 if (bar)
3804 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
3805 win_x = parent_x;
3806 win_y = parent_y;
3810 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
3811 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
3813 if (f1)
3815 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
3816 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
3817 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
3818 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
3819 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
3820 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
3821 the frame are divided into. */
3823 int width, height, gx, gy;
3824 XRectangle rect;
3826 if (glyph_rect (f1, win_x, win_y, &rect))
3827 last_mouse_glyph = rect;
3828 else
3830 width = FRAME_SMALLEST_CHAR_WIDTH (f1);
3831 height = FRAME_SMALLEST_FONT_HEIGHT (f1);
3832 gx = win_x;
3833 gy = win_y;
3835 /* Arrange for the division in FRAME_PIXEL_X_TO_COL etc. to
3836 round down even for negative values. */
3837 if (gx < 0)
3838 gx -= width - 1;
3839 if (gy < 0)
3840 gy -= height - 1;
3841 gx = (gx + width - 1) / width * width;
3842 gy = (gy + height - 1) / height * height;
3844 last_mouse_glyph.width = width;
3845 last_mouse_glyph.height = height;
3846 last_mouse_glyph.x = gx;
3847 last_mouse_glyph.y = gy;
3850 *bar_window = Qnil;
3851 *part = 0;
3852 *fp = f1;
3853 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
3854 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
3855 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
3860 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3865 /***********************************************************************
3866 Scroll bars
3867 ***********************************************************************/
3869 /* Scroll bar support. */
3871 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
3872 manages it.
3873 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
3874 bits. */
3876 static struct scroll_bar *
3877 x_window_to_scroll_bar (display, window_id)
3878 Display *display;
3879 Window window_id;
3881 Lisp_Object tail;
3883 #ifdef USE_GTK
3884 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
3885 #endif /* USE_GTK */
3887 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3888 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3889 tail = XCDR (tail))
3891 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
3893 frame = XCAR (tail);
3894 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
3895 if (! GC_FRAMEP (frame))
3896 abort ();
3898 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
3899 right window ID. */
3900 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3901 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
3902 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
3903 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
3904 ! GC_NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
3905 condemned = Qnil,
3906 ! GC_NILP (bar));
3907 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
3908 if (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)) == window_id &&
3909 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
3910 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
3913 return 0;
3917 #if defined USE_LUCID
3919 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
3920 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
3922 static Widget
3923 x_window_to_menu_bar (window)
3924 Window window;
3926 Lisp_Object tail;
3928 for (tail = Vframe_list;
3929 XGCTYPE (tail) == Lisp_Cons;
3930 tail = XCDR (tail))
3932 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
3933 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
3935 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
3936 return menu_bar;
3939 return NULL;
3942 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
3945 /************************************************************************
3946 Toolkit scroll bars
3947 ************************************************************************/
3949 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3951 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event P_ ((XEvent *, struct input_event *));
3952 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event P_ ((Lisp_Object, int, int, int));
3953 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar P_ ((struct frame *,
3954 struct scroll_bar *));
3955 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb P_ ((struct scroll_bar *,
3956 int, int, int));
3959 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
3960 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
3962 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
3964 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
3966 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
3968 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
3969 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
3971 #ifndef USE_GTK
3972 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
3974 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
3976 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
3978 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
3979 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
3980 to avoid jerkyness. */
3982 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
3984 extern void set_vertical_scroll_bar P_ ((struct window *));
3986 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
3987 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
3988 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
3989 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
3991 static void
3992 xt_action_hook (widget, client_data, action_name, event, params,
3993 num_params)
3994 Widget widget;
3995 XtPointer client_data;
3996 String action_name;
3997 XEvent *event;
3998 String *params;
3999 Cardinal *num_params;
4001 int scroll_bar_p;
4002 char *end_action;
4004 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4005 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4006 end_action = "Release";
4007 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4008 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4009 end_action = "EndScroll";
4010 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4012 if (scroll_bar_p
4013 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4014 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4016 struct window *w;
4018 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4019 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4020 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4022 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4024 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4025 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4026 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4028 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4029 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4031 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4032 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4035 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4037 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4038 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4040 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4041 static int scroll_bar_windows_size;
4044 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4045 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4046 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4047 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4049 static void
4050 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window, part, portion, whole)
4051 Lisp_Object window;
4052 int part, portion, whole;
4054 XEvent event;
4055 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4056 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4057 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4058 int i;
4060 BLOCK_INPUT;
4062 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4063 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4064 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4065 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4066 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4067 ev->format = 32;
4069 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4070 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4071 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4072 into that array in the event. */
4073 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4074 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4075 break;
4077 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4079 int new_size = max (10, 2 * scroll_bar_windows_size);
4080 size_t nbytes = new_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4081 size_t old_nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4083 scroll_bar_windows = (struct window **) xrealloc (scroll_bar_windows,
4084 nbytes);
4085 bzero (&scroll_bar_windows[i], nbytes - old_nbytes);
4086 scroll_bar_windows_size = new_size;
4089 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4090 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4091 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4092 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4093 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4094 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4096 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4097 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4099 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4100 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4101 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4102 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4103 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4107 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4108 in *IEVENT. */
4110 static void
4111 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (event, ievent)
4112 XEvent *event;
4113 struct input_event *ievent;
4115 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4116 Lisp_Object window;
4117 struct frame *f;
4118 struct window *w;
4120 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4121 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4123 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4124 f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4126 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4127 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4128 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4129 #ifdef USE_GTK
4130 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4131 #else
4132 ievent->timestamp = XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
4133 #endif
4134 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4135 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4136 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4137 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4138 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4142 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4144 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4146 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4149 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4150 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4151 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4153 static void
4154 xm_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4155 Widget widget;
4156 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4158 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4159 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4160 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4162 switch (cs->reason)
4164 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4165 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4166 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4167 break;
4169 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4170 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4171 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4172 break;
4174 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4175 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4176 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4177 break;
4179 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4180 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4181 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4182 break;
4184 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4185 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4186 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4187 break;
4189 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4190 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4191 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4192 break;
4194 case XmCR_DRAG:
4196 int slider_size;
4198 /* Get the slider size. */
4199 BLOCK_INPUT;
4200 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4201 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4203 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4204 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4205 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4206 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4208 break;
4210 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4211 break;
4214 if (part >= 0)
4216 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4217 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4218 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4223 #else /* !USE_MOTIF, i.e. Xaw or GTK */
4224 #ifdef USE_GTK
4225 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4226 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4228 static void
4229 xg_scroll_callback (widget, data)
4230 GtkRange *widget;
4231 gpointer data;
4233 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) data;
4234 gdouble previous;
4235 gdouble position;
4236 gdouble *p;
4237 int diff;
4239 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4240 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (widget));
4242 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return;
4244 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4246 p = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA);
4247 if (! p)
4249 p = (gdouble*) xmalloc (sizeof (gdouble));
4250 *p = XG_SB_MIN;
4251 g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), XG_LAST_SB_DATA, p);
4254 previous = *p;
4255 *p = position;
4257 diff = (int) (position - previous);
4259 if (diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4261 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4262 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4264 else if (-diff == (int) adj->step_increment)
4266 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4267 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4269 else if (diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4271 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4272 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4274 else if (-diff == (int) adj->page_increment)
4276 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4277 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4279 else
4281 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4282 whole = adj->upper - adj->page_size;
4283 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4284 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4287 if (part >= 0)
4289 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4290 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4291 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4295 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4297 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4298 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4299 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4300 the thumb is. */
4302 static void
4303 xaw_jump_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4304 Widget widget;
4305 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4307 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4308 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4309 float shown;
4310 int whole, portion, height;
4311 int part;
4313 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4314 BLOCK_INPUT;
4315 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4316 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4318 whole = 10000000;
4319 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4321 if (shown < 1 && (abs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0/height))
4322 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4323 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4324 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4325 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4326 bottom). */
4327 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4328 else
4329 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4331 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4332 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4333 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4334 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4338 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4339 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4340 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4341 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4342 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4343 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4344 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4346 static void
4347 xaw_scroll_callback (widget, client_data, call_data)
4348 Widget widget;
4349 XtPointer client_data, call_data;
4351 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4352 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4353 int position = (long) call_data;
4354 Dimension height;
4355 int part;
4357 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4358 BLOCK_INPUT;
4359 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4360 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4362 if (abs (position) >= height)
4363 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4365 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4366 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4367 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && abs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4368 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4369 else
4370 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4372 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4373 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4374 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4375 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4378 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4379 #endif /* not USE_MOTIF */
4381 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4383 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4384 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4386 #ifdef USE_GTK
4387 static void
4388 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4389 struct frame *f;
4390 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4392 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4394 BLOCK_INPUT;
4395 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4396 scroll_bar_name);
4397 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4400 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4402 static void
4403 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar)
4404 struct frame *f;
4405 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4407 Window xwindow;
4408 Widget widget;
4409 Arg av[20];
4410 int ac = 0;
4411 char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4412 unsigned long pixel;
4414 BLOCK_INPUT;
4416 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4417 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4418 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4419 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4420 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4421 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4422 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4423 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4424 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4426 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4427 if (pixel != -1)
4429 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4430 ++ac;
4433 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4434 if (pixel != -1)
4436 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4437 ++ac;
4440 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4441 scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4443 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4444 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4445 (XtPointer) bar);
4446 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4447 (XtPointer) bar);
4448 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4449 (XtPointer) bar);
4450 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4451 (XtPointer) bar);
4452 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4453 (XtPointer) bar);
4454 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4455 (XtPointer) bar);
4456 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4457 (XtPointer) bar);
4459 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4460 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4462 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4463 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4464 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4465 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4467 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4469 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4470 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4471 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4472 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4473 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4474 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4475 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4476 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4478 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4479 if (pixel != -1)
4481 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4482 ++ac;
4485 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4486 if (pixel != -1)
4488 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4489 ++ac;
4492 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4494 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4495 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4497 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4498 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4499 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4500 pixel = -1;
4501 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4503 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4505 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4506 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4507 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4508 pixel = -1;
4509 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4512 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4513 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4514 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4515 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4516 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4518 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, True);
4519 ++ac;
4521 else
4522 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4523 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4524 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4526 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4527 the shadows. */
4528 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4529 ++ac;
4531 /* Specify the colors. */
4532 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4533 if (pixel != -1)
4535 XtSetArg (av[ac], "topShadowPixel", pixel);
4536 ++ac;
4538 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4539 if (pixel != -1)
4541 XtSetArg (av[ac], "bottomShadowPixel", pixel);
4542 ++ac;
4546 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4547 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4550 char *initial = "";
4551 char *val = initial;
4552 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4553 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4554 if (val == initial)
4555 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4556 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4557 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? -sm */
4558 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4562 /* Define callbacks. */
4563 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4564 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4565 (XtPointer) bar);
4567 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4568 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4570 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4572 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4573 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4574 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4575 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4577 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4578 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4579 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4580 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, xwindow);
4582 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4584 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4587 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4588 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4590 #ifdef USE_GTK
4591 static void
4592 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4593 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4594 int portion, position, whole;
4596 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4599 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4600 static void
4601 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole)
4602 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4603 int portion, position, whole;
4605 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4606 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4607 float top, shown;
4609 BLOCK_INPUT;
4611 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4613 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4614 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4615 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4616 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4617 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4618 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4619 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4620 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4621 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4622 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4623 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4624 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4625 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4626 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4627 whole += portion;
4629 if (whole <= 0)
4630 top = 0, shown = 1;
4631 else
4633 top = (float) position / whole;
4634 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4637 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4639 int size, value;
4641 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4642 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4643 value. */
4644 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4645 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4646 size = max (size, 1);
4648 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4649 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4650 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4652 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4654 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4656 if (whole == 0)
4657 top = 0, shown = 1;
4658 else
4660 top = (float) position / whole;
4661 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4665 float old_top, old_shown;
4666 Dimension height;
4667 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4668 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4669 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4670 XtNheight, &height,
4671 NULL);
4673 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4674 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4675 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4676 else
4677 top = old_top;
4678 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4679 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0 / height), shown));
4681 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4682 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4683 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4684 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4686 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4687 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4688 else
4690 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4691 ScrollbarWidget sb = (ScrollbarWidget) widget;
4692 int scroll_mode = 0;
4694 /* `scroll_mode' only exists with Xaw3d + ARROW_SCROLLBAR. */
4695 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll)
4697 /* Xaw3d stupidly ignores resize requests while dragging
4698 so we have to make it believe it's not in dragging mode. */
4699 scroll_mode = sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode;
4700 if (scroll_mode == 2)
4701 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = 0;
4703 #endif
4704 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4705 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4706 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4708 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4710 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
4711 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && scroll_mode == 2)
4712 sb->scrollbar.scroll_mode = scroll_mode;
4713 #endif
4717 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4719 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4721 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4723 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4727 /************************************************************************
4728 Scroll bars, general
4729 ************************************************************************/
4731 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4732 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4733 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4734 scroll bar. */
4736 static struct scroll_bar *
4737 x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, left, width, height)
4738 struct window *w;
4739 int top, left, width, height;
4741 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4742 struct scroll_bar *bar
4743 = XSCROLL_BAR (Fmake_vector (make_number (SCROLL_BAR_VEC_SIZE), Qnil));
4745 BLOCK_INPUT;
4747 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4748 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4749 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4751 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4752 unsigned long mask;
4753 Window window;
4755 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4756 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4757 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->background_pixel;
4759 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4760 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4761 | ExposureMask);
4762 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4764 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4766 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4767 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4768 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4769 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4770 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4771 left, top, width,
4772 window_box_height (w), False);
4774 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4775 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4776 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4777 top,
4778 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4779 height,
4780 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4782 CopyFromParent,
4783 CopyFromParent,
4784 CopyFromParent,
4785 /* Attributes. */
4786 mask, &a);
4787 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar, window);
4789 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4791 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4792 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
4793 XSETINT (bar->left, left);
4794 XSETINT (bar->width, width);
4795 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
4796 XSETINT (bar->start, 0);
4797 XSETINT (bar->end, 0);
4798 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4800 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
4801 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
4802 bar->prev = Qnil;
4803 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
4804 if (!NILP (bar->next))
4805 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
4807 /* Map the window/widget. */
4808 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4810 #ifdef USE_GTK
4811 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
4812 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
4813 top,
4814 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4815 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4816 max (height, 1),
4817 left,
4818 width);
4819 xg_show_scroll_bar (SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4820 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4821 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4822 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
4823 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4824 top,
4825 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4826 max (height, 1), 0);
4827 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
4828 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4830 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4831 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4832 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4834 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4835 return bar;
4839 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
4841 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
4842 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
4843 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
4844 events.)
4846 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
4847 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
4848 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
4849 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
4850 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
4852 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4854 static void
4855 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, rebuild)
4856 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4857 int start, end;
4858 int rebuild;
4860 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
4861 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
4862 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4863 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
4865 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
4866 if (! rebuild
4867 && start == XINT (bar->start)
4868 && end == XINT (bar->end))
4869 return;
4871 BLOCK_INPUT;
4874 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, XINT (bar->width));
4875 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
4876 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
4878 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
4879 the distance between start and end. */
4881 int length = end - start;
4883 if (start < 0)
4884 start = 0;
4885 else if (start > top_range)
4886 start = top_range;
4887 end = start + length;
4889 if (end < start)
4890 end = start;
4891 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
4892 end = top_range;
4895 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
4896 XSETINT (bar->start, start);
4897 XSETINT (bar->end, end);
4899 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
4900 if (end > top_range)
4901 end = top_range;
4903 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
4904 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
4905 that many pixels tall. */
4906 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
4908 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
4909 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4910 if (0 < start)
4911 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4912 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4913 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4914 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
4915 inside_width, start,
4916 False);
4918 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
4919 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4920 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4921 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
4923 /* Draw the handle itself. */
4924 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
4925 /* x, y, width, height */
4926 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4927 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
4928 inside_width, end - start);
4930 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
4931 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
4932 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
4933 f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
4935 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
4936 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
4937 if (end < inside_height)
4938 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
4939 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
4940 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
4941 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
4942 inside_width, inside_height - end,
4943 False);
4947 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4950 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4952 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
4953 nil. */
4955 static void
4956 x_scroll_bar_remove (bar)
4957 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4959 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4960 BLOCK_INPUT;
4962 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4963 #ifdef USE_GTK
4964 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4965 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4966 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
4967 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4968 #else
4969 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar));
4970 #endif
4972 /* Disassociate this scroll bar from its window. */
4973 XWINDOW (bar->window)->vertical_scroll_bar = Qnil;
4975 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4979 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
4980 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
4981 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
4982 create one. */
4984 static void
4985 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, portion, whole, position)
4986 struct window *w;
4987 int portion, whole, position;
4989 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4990 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4991 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
4992 int window_y, window_height;
4994 /* Get window dimensions. */
4995 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
4996 top = window_y;
4997 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
4998 height = window_height;
5000 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5001 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5003 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5004 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5005 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5006 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5007 else
5008 sb_width = width;
5010 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5011 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5012 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5013 sb_left = left + width - sb_width - (width - sb_width) / 2;
5014 else
5015 sb_left = left + (width - sb_width) / 2;
5016 #else
5017 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5018 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5019 else
5020 sb_left = left;
5021 #endif
5023 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5024 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5026 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5028 BLOCK_INPUT;
5029 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5030 left, top, width, height, False);
5031 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5034 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5036 else
5038 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5039 unsigned int mask = 0;
5041 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5043 BLOCK_INPUT;
5045 if (sb_left != XINT (bar->left))
5046 mask |= CWX;
5047 if (top != XINT (bar->top))
5048 mask |= CWY;
5049 if (sb_width != XINT (bar->width))
5050 mask |= CWWidth;
5051 if (height != XINT (bar->height))
5052 mask |= CWHeight;
5054 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5056 #ifdef USE_GTK
5057 if (mask)
5058 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5059 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5060 top,
5061 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5062 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5063 max (height, 1),
5064 left,
5065 width);
5066 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5068 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5069 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5070 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5071 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5072 left, top, width, height, False);
5073 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5074 if (mask)
5075 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5076 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5077 top,
5078 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5079 max (height, 1), 0);
5081 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5082 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5084 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5085 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5086 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5088 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5089 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5090 height, False);
5091 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5092 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5093 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5094 height, False);
5097 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5098 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5099 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5100 example. */
5102 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5103 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5104 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5106 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5107 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5108 left + area_width - rest, top,
5109 rest, height, False);
5110 else
5111 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5112 left, top, rest, height, False);
5116 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5117 if (mask)
5119 XWindowChanges wc;
5121 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5122 wc.y = top;
5123 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5124 wc.height = height;
5125 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar),
5126 mask, &wc);
5129 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5131 /* Remember new settings. */
5132 XSETINT (bar->left, sb_left);
5133 XSETINT (bar->top, top);
5134 XSETINT (bar->width, sb_width);
5135 XSETINT (bar->height, height);
5137 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5140 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5141 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5142 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5143 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5144 dragged. */
5145 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5147 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5149 if (whole == 0)
5150 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5151 else
5153 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5154 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5155 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5158 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5160 XSETVECTOR (w->vertical_scroll_bar, bar);
5164 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5165 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5166 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5167 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5168 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5169 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5170 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5172 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5173 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5174 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5176 static void
5177 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (frame)
5178 FRAME_PTR frame;
5180 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5181 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5183 Lisp_Object bar;
5184 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5185 FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next;
5186 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5187 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5188 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5189 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5190 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame) = bar;
5195 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5196 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5198 static void
5199 XTredeem_scroll_bar (window)
5200 struct window *window;
5202 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5203 struct frame *f;
5205 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5206 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5207 abort ();
5209 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5211 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5212 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5213 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5215 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5216 the lists. */
5217 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5218 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5219 return;
5220 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5221 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5222 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = bar->next;
5223 else
5224 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5225 one or the other! */
5226 abort ();
5228 else
5229 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5231 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5232 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5234 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5235 bar->prev = Qnil;
5236 XSETVECTOR (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), bar);
5237 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5238 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5241 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5242 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5244 static void
5245 XTjudge_scroll_bars (f)
5246 FRAME_PTR f;
5248 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5250 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5252 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5253 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5254 FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f) = Qnil;
5256 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5258 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5260 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5262 next = b->next;
5263 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5266 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5267 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5271 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5272 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5273 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5275 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5276 mark bits. */
5278 static void
5279 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, event)
5280 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5281 XEvent *event;
5283 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5284 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5285 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5286 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5288 BLOCK_INPUT;
5290 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, XINT (bar->start), XINT (bar->end), 1);
5292 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5293 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5295 /* x, y, width, height */
5296 0, 0,
5297 XINT (bar->width) - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5298 XINT (bar->height) - 1);
5300 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5303 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5305 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5306 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5308 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5309 mark bits. */
5312 static void
5313 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, event, emacs_event)
5314 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5315 XEvent *event;
5316 struct input_event *emacs_event;
5318 if (! GC_WINDOWP (bar->window))
5319 abort ();
5321 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5322 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5323 emacs_event->modifiers
5324 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5325 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5326 event->xbutton.state)
5327 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5328 ? up_modifier
5329 : down_modifier));
5330 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5331 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5332 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5334 #if 0
5335 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5336 int internal_height
5337 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5338 #endif
5339 int top_range
5340 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5341 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5343 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5344 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5346 if (y < XINT (bar->start))
5347 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5348 else if (y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5349 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5350 else
5351 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5353 /* Just because the user has clicked on the handle doesn't mean
5354 they want to drag it. Lisp code needs to be able to decide
5355 whether or not we're dragging. */
5356 #if 0
5357 /* If the user has just clicked on the handle, record where they're
5358 holding it. */
5359 if (event->type == ButtonPress
5360 && emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5361 XSETINT (bar->dragging, y - XINT (bar->start));
5362 #endif
5364 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5365 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5366 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5367 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5369 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5370 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5372 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5373 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5375 #endif
5377 /* Same deal here as the other #if 0. */
5378 #if 0
5379 /* Clicks on the handle are always reported as occurring at the top of
5380 the handle. */
5381 if (emacs_event->part == scroll_bar_handle)
5382 emacs_event->x = bar->start;
5383 else
5384 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5385 #else
5386 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5387 #endif
5389 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5393 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5395 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5397 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5398 mark bits. */
5400 static void
5401 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, event)
5402 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5403 XEvent *event;
5405 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5407 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5409 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5410 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5412 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5413 if (! GC_NILP (bar->dragging))
5415 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5416 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5418 if (new_start != XINT (bar->start))
5420 int new_end = new_start + (XINT (bar->end) - XINT (bar->start));
5422 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5427 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5429 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5430 on the scroll bar. */
5432 static void
5433 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, time)
5434 FRAME_PTR *fp;
5435 Lisp_Object *bar_window;
5436 enum scroll_bar_part *part;
5437 Lisp_Object *x, *y;
5438 unsigned long *time;
5440 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5441 Window w = SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (bar);
5442 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5443 int win_x, win_y;
5444 Window dummy_window;
5445 int dummy_coord;
5446 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5448 BLOCK_INPUT;
5450 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5451 report that. */
5452 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5454 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5455 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5456 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5458 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5459 &win_x, &win_y,
5461 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5462 &dummy_mask))
5464 else
5466 #if 0
5467 int inside_height
5468 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, XINT (bar->height));
5469 #endif
5470 int top_range
5471 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, XINT (bar->height));
5473 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5475 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5476 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5478 if (win_y < 0)
5479 win_y = 0;
5480 if (win_y > top_range)
5481 win_y = top_range;
5483 *fp = f;
5484 *bar_window = bar->window;
5486 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5487 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5488 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->start))
5489 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5490 else if (win_y < XINT (bar->end) + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5491 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5492 else
5493 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5495 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5496 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5498 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5499 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5502 *time = last_mouse_movement_time;
5504 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5508 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5509 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5510 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5511 redraw them. */
5513 void
5514 x_scroll_bar_clear (f)
5515 FRAME_PTR f;
5517 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5518 Lisp_Object bar;
5520 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5521 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5522 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5523 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5524 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5525 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5526 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5527 SCROLL_BAR_X_WINDOW (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)),
5528 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5529 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5533 /* Define a queue to save up SelectionRequest events for later handling. */
5535 struct selection_event_queue
5537 XEvent event;
5538 struct selection_event_queue *next;
5541 static struct selection_event_queue *queue;
5543 /* Nonzero means queue up certain events--don't process them yet. */
5545 static int x_queue_selection_requests;
5547 /* Queue up an X event *EVENT, to be processed later. */
5549 static void
5550 x_queue_event (f, event)
5551 FRAME_PTR f;
5552 XEvent *event;
5554 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp
5555 = (struct selection_event_queue *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct selection_event_queue));
5557 if (queue_tmp != NULL)
5559 queue_tmp->event = *event;
5560 queue_tmp->next = queue;
5561 queue = queue_tmp;
5565 /* Take all the queued events and put them back
5566 so that they get processed afresh. */
5568 static void
5569 x_unqueue_events (display)
5570 Display *display;
5572 while (queue != NULL)
5574 struct selection_event_queue *queue_tmp = queue;
5575 XPutBackEvent (display, &queue_tmp->event);
5576 queue = queue_tmp->next;
5577 xfree ((char *)queue_tmp);
5581 /* Start queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5583 void
5584 x_start_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5585 Display *display;
5587 x_queue_selection_requests++;
5590 /* Stop queuing SelectionRequest events. */
5592 void
5593 x_stop_queuing_selection_requests (display)
5594 Display *display;
5596 x_queue_selection_requests--;
5597 x_unqueue_events (display);
5600 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5602 #if 0
5603 /* Time stamp of enter window event. This is only used by XTread_socket,
5604 but we have to put it out here, since static variables within functions
5605 sometimes don't work. */
5607 static Time enter_timestamp;
5608 #endif
5610 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5611 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5612 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5613 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5615 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5616 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5618 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5620 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5621 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5623 static int temp_index;
5624 static short temp_buffer[100];
5626 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5627 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5628 temp_index = 0; \
5629 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5631 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5632 on a particular display. */
5634 struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5636 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5637 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5638 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5639 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5641 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5643 #define SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT(size) \
5644 do \
5646 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5647 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event \
5648 = (XEvent *) xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5649 bcopy (&event, f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event, size); \
5650 inev.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5651 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f); \
5653 while (0)
5655 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XButtonEvent))
5656 #define SET_SAVED_KEY_EVENT SET_SAVED_MENU_EVENT (sizeof (XKeyEvent))
5659 enum
5661 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5662 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5663 X_EVENT_DROP
5666 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5667 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5668 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5670 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5671 this event further.
5672 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5674 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5675 static int
5676 x_filter_event (dpyinfo, event)
5677 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5678 XEvent *event;
5680 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5681 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5682 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5683 was created. */
5685 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5686 event->xclient.window);
5688 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5690 #endif
5692 #ifdef USE_GTK
5693 static int current_count;
5694 static int current_finish;
5695 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5697 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5698 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5699 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5700 static GdkFilterReturn
5701 event_handler_gdk (gxev, ev, data)
5702 GdkXEvent *gxev;
5703 GdkEvent *ev;
5704 gpointer data;
5706 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5708 if (current_count >= 0)
5710 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5712 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5714 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5715 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5716 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5717 so we do it here. */
5718 if (xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5719 if (dpyinfo && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5720 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5721 #endif
5723 if (! dpyinfo)
5724 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5725 else
5727 current_count +=
5728 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5729 current_hold_quit);
5732 else
5733 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5735 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5736 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5738 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5740 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5743 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5745 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5746 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5747 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5749 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5751 static int
5752 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, eventp, finish, hold_quit)
5753 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5754 XEvent *eventp;
5755 int *finish;
5756 struct input_event *hold_quit;
5758 struct input_event inev;
5759 int count = 0;
5760 int do_help = 0;
5761 int nbytes = 0;
5762 struct frame *f;
5763 struct coding_system coding;
5764 XEvent event = *eventp;
5766 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5768 EVENT_INIT (inev);
5769 inev.kind = NO_EVENT;
5770 inev.arg = Qnil;
5772 switch (event.type)
5774 case ClientMessage:
5776 if (event.xclient.message_type
5777 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5778 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5780 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5781 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5783 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5784 could be the shell widget window
5785 if the frame has no title bar. */
5786 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5787 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5788 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5789 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5790 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5791 #endif
5792 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5793 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5794 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5795 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5796 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5797 needed.
5799 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5800 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5801 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5802 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5803 Emacs. */
5805 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5806 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5807 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5808 if (f)
5810 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5811 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5812 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5813 int count = x_catch_errors (d);
5814 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5815 /* The ICCCM says this is
5816 the only valid choice. */
5817 RevertToParent,
5818 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5819 /* This is needed to detect the error
5820 if there is an error. */
5821 XSync (d, False);
5822 x_uncatch_errors (d, count);
5824 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5825 #endif /* 0 */
5826 goto done;
5829 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5830 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5832 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5833 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5834 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5835 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5836 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5837 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5838 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5839 session manager and one for this. */
5840 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5841 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5842 #endif
5844 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5845 event.xclient.window);
5846 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5847 for a single Emacs process. */
5848 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5849 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5850 event.xclient.window,
5851 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5852 else if (f)
5853 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5854 event.xclient.window,
5855 0, 0);
5857 goto done;
5860 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5861 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5863 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5864 event.xclient.window);
5865 if (!f)
5866 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5868 inev.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5869 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
5870 goto done;
5873 goto done;
5876 if (event.xclient.message_type
5877 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
5879 goto done;
5882 if (event.xclient.message_type
5883 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
5885 int new_x, new_y;
5886 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5888 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
5889 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
5891 if (f)
5893 f->left_pos = new_x;
5894 f->top_pos = new_y;
5896 goto done;
5899 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
5900 if (event.xclient.message_type
5901 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
5903 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5904 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
5905 &event, NULL);
5906 goto done;
5908 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
5910 if ((event.xclient.message_type
5911 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
5912 || (event.xclient.message_type
5913 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
5915 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
5916 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
5917 currently never do because we are interested in
5918 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
5919 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
5920 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5921 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
5922 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
5923 goto done;
5926 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5927 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
5928 we construct an input_event. */
5929 if (event.xclient.message_type
5930 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
5932 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev);
5933 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
5934 goto done;
5936 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5938 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5940 if (!f)
5941 goto OTHER;
5943 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev))
5944 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
5946 break;
5948 case SelectionNotify:
5949 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5950 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
5951 goto OTHER;
5952 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5953 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
5954 break;
5956 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
5957 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5958 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
5959 goto OTHER;
5960 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5962 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = (XSelectionClearEvent *) &event;
5964 inev.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
5965 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
5966 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
5967 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
5968 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5970 break;
5972 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
5973 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
5974 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
5975 goto OTHER;
5976 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
5977 if (x_queue_selection_requests)
5978 x_queue_event (x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner),
5979 &event);
5980 else
5982 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp
5983 = (XSelectionRequestEvent *) &event;
5985 inev.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
5986 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev) = eventp->display;
5987 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev) = eventp->requestor;
5988 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev) = eventp->selection;
5989 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev) = eventp->target;
5990 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev) = eventp->property;
5991 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev) = eventp->time;
5992 inev.frame_or_window = Qnil;
5994 break;
5996 case PropertyNotify:
5997 #if 0 /* This is plain wrong. In the case that we are waiting for a
5998 PropertyNotify used as an ACK in incremental selection
5999 transfer, the property will be on the receiver's window. */
6000 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
6001 if (!x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window))
6002 goto OTHER;
6003 #endif
6004 #endif
6005 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6006 goto OTHER;
6008 case ReparentNotify:
6009 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6010 if (f)
6012 int x, y;
6013 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6014 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6015 f->left_pos = x;
6016 f->top_pos = y;
6018 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6019 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6021 goto OTHER;
6023 case Expose:
6024 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6025 if (f)
6027 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6029 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6031 f->async_visible = 1;
6032 f->async_iconified = 0;
6033 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6034 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6036 else
6037 expose_frame (f,
6038 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6039 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6041 else
6043 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6044 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6045 #endif
6046 #if defined USE_LUCID
6047 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6048 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6049 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6051 Widget widget
6052 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6053 if (widget)
6054 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6056 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6058 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6059 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6060 goto OTHER;
6061 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6062 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6063 event.xexpose.window);
6065 if (bar)
6066 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6067 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6068 else
6069 goto OTHER;
6070 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6071 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6073 break;
6075 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6076 source area was obscured or not
6077 available. */
6078 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6079 if (f)
6081 expose_frame (f,
6082 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6083 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6084 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6086 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6087 else
6088 goto OTHER;
6089 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6090 break;
6092 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6093 source area was completely
6094 available. */
6095 break;
6097 case UnmapNotify:
6098 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6099 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6101 tip_window = 0;
6102 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6105 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6106 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6107 the frame was deleted. */
6109 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6110 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6111 display that won't ever be seen. */
6112 f->async_visible = 0;
6113 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6114 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6115 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6116 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6117 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6118 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6119 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6121 f->async_iconified = 1;
6123 inev.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6124 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6127 goto OTHER;
6129 case MapNotify:
6130 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6131 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6132 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6133 goto OTHER;
6135 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6136 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6137 frame is visible. */
6138 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6139 if (f)
6141 /* wait_reading_process_input will notice this and update
6142 the frame's display structures.
6143 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6144 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6145 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6146 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6147 if (! f->async_iconified)
6148 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6150 f->async_visible = 1;
6151 f->async_iconified = 0;
6152 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6154 if (f->iconified)
6156 inev.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6157 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6159 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6160 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6161 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6162 to update the frame titles
6163 in case this is the second frame. */
6164 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6166 goto OTHER;
6168 case KeyPress:
6170 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6171 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6172 if (popup_activated ())
6173 goto OTHER;
6174 #endif
6176 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6178 if (!dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight))
6180 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6181 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6184 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6185 if (f == 0)
6187 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6188 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6189 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6190 event.xkey.window);
6191 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6193 widget = XtParent (widget);
6194 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6197 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6199 if (f != 0)
6201 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6202 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6203 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6204 his Emacs hang.
6206 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6207 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6208 status_return even if the input is too long to
6209 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6210 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6211 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6212 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6213 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6214 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6215 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6216 int modifiers;
6217 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6218 Lisp_Object c;
6220 #ifdef USE_GTK
6221 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6222 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6223 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6224 (see above). */
6225 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6226 #endif
6228 event.xkey.state
6229 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6230 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6231 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6233 /* This will have to go some day... */
6235 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6236 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6237 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6238 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6239 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6240 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6241 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6243 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6244 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6245 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6246 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6247 not it is combined with Meta. */
6248 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6249 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6251 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6252 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6254 Status status_return;
6256 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6257 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6258 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6259 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6260 &status_return);
6261 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6263 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6264 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6265 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6266 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6267 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6268 &status_return);
6270 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6271 #if 0 && defined X_HAVE_UTF8_STRING
6272 else if (status_return == XLookupKeySym)
6273 { /* Try again but with utf-8. */
6274 coding_system = Qutf_8;
6275 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6276 &event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6277 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6278 &status_return);
6279 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6281 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6282 copy_bufptr = (char *) alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6283 nbytes = Xutf8LookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6284 &event.xkey,
6285 copy_bufptr,
6286 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6287 &status_return);
6290 #endif
6292 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6293 break;
6294 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6296 keysym = NoSymbol;
6297 modifiers = 0;
6299 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6300 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6301 abort ();
6303 else
6304 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6305 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6306 &compose_status);
6307 #else
6308 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, copy_bufptr,
6309 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6310 &compose_status);
6311 #endif
6313 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6314 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6315 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6316 break;
6318 orig_keysym = keysym;
6320 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6321 XSETFRAME (inev.frame_or_window, f);
6322 inev.modifiers
6323 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6324 inev.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6326 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6327 translations to characters. */
6328 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6329 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6331 inev.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6332 inev.code = keysym;
6333 goto done_keysym;
6336 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6337 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6338 && (NATNUMP (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6339 Vx_keysym_table,
6340 Qnil))))
6342 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6343 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6344 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6345 inev.code = XFASTINT (c);
6346 goto done_keysym;
6349 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6350 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6351 || keysym == XK_Delete
6352 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6353 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6354 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6355 #endif
6356 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6357 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6358 #ifdef HPUX
6359 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6360 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6361 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6362 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6363 || ((unsigned) (keysym) >= XK_Select
6364 && (unsigned)(keysym) < XK_KP_Space)
6365 #endif
6366 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6367 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6368 #endif
6369 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6370 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6371 #endif
6372 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6373 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6374 #endif
6375 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6376 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6377 #endif
6378 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6379 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6380 #endif
6381 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6382 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6383 #endif
6384 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6385 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6386 #endif
6387 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6388 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6389 #endif
6390 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6391 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6392 #endif
6393 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6394 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6395 #endif
6396 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6397 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6398 #endif
6399 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6400 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6401 #endif
6402 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6403 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6404 #endif
6405 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6406 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6407 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6408 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6409 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6410 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6411 #ifndef HAVE_X11R5
6412 #ifdef XK_Mode_switch
6413 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Mode_switch)
6414 #endif
6415 #ifdef XK_Num_Lock
6416 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym) == XK_Num_Lock)
6417 #endif
6418 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R5 */
6419 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6420 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6421 don't have real modifiers but
6422 should be treated similarly to
6423 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6424 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6425 || ((unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6426 >= XK_ISO_Lock
6427 && (unsigned)(orig_keysym)
6428 <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6429 #endif
6432 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6433 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6434 key. */
6435 inev.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6436 inev.code = keysym;
6437 goto done_keysym;
6440 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6441 register int i;
6442 register int c;
6443 int nchars, len;
6445 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6446 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6447 we used just above and the locale. */
6448 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6449 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6450 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6451 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6452 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6453 gives us composition information. */
6454 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6456 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6458 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6462 /* Decode the input data. */
6463 int require;
6464 unsigned char *p;
6466 require = decoding_buffer_size (&coding, nbytes);
6467 p = (unsigned char *) alloca (require);
6468 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6469 /* We explicitly disable composition handling because
6470 key data should not contain any composition sequence. */
6471 coding.composing = COMPOSITION_DISABLED;
6472 decode_coding (&coding, copy_bufptr, p, nbytes, require);
6473 nbytes = coding.produced;
6474 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6475 copy_bufptr = p;
6478 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6479 character events. */
6480 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6482 if (nchars == nbytes)
6483 c = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6484 else
6485 c = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i,
6486 nbytes - i, len);
6487 inev.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (c)
6488 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6489 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6490 inev.code = c;
6491 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6494 /* Previous code updated count by nchars rather than nbytes,
6495 but that seems bogus to me. ++kfs */
6496 count += nbytes;
6498 inev.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6500 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6501 break;
6504 done_keysym:
6505 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6506 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6507 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6508 client. */
6509 break;
6510 #else
6511 goto OTHER;
6512 #endif
6514 case KeyRelease:
6515 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6516 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6517 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6518 client. */
6519 break;
6520 #else
6521 goto OTHER;
6522 #endif
6524 case EnterNotify:
6525 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6527 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6529 #if 0
6530 if (event.xcrossing.focus)
6532 /* Avoid nasty pop/raise loops. */
6533 if (f && (!(f->auto_raise)
6534 || !(f->auto_lower)
6535 || (event.xcrossing.time - enter_timestamp) > 500))
6537 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, f);
6538 enter_timestamp = event.xcrossing.time;
6541 else if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6542 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
6543 #endif
6545 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6546 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6547 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6548 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6549 goto OTHER;
6551 case FocusIn:
6552 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6553 goto OTHER;
6555 case LeaveNotify:
6556 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6558 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6559 if (f)
6561 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6563 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6564 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6565 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6566 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6569 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6570 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6571 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6572 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6573 if (any_help_event_p)
6574 do_help = -1;
6576 goto OTHER;
6578 case FocusOut:
6579 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev);
6580 goto OTHER;
6582 case MotionNotify:
6584 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6585 help_echo_string = help_echo_object = help_echo_window = Qnil;
6586 help_echo_pos = -1;
6588 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6589 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6590 f = last_mouse_frame;
6591 else
6592 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6594 if (dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6596 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6597 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6600 if (f)
6603 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed. */
6604 if (mouse_autoselect_window)
6606 Lisp_Object window;
6608 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6609 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6610 0, 0, 0, 0);
6612 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6613 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6614 will be selected iff it is active. */
6615 if (WINDOWP (window)
6616 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6617 && !EQ (window, selected_window))
6619 inev.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6620 inev.frame_or_window = window;
6623 last_window=window;
6625 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6627 else
6629 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6630 struct scroll_bar *bar
6631 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6632 event.xmotion.window);
6634 if (bar)
6635 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6636 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6638 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6639 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6640 clear_mouse_face (dpyinfo);
6643 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6644 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6645 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6646 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6647 do_help = 1;
6648 goto OTHER;
6651 case ConfigureNotify:
6652 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6653 if (f)
6655 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6656 #ifdef USE_GTK
6657 xg_resize_widgets (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6658 event.xconfigure.height);
6659 #else /* not USE_GTK */
6660 /* If there is a pending resize for fullscreen, don't
6661 do this one, the right one will come later.
6662 The toolkit version doesn't seem to need this, but we
6663 need to reset it below. */
6664 int dont_resize
6665 = ((f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6666 && f->new_text_cols != 0);
6667 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6668 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6670 if (dont_resize)
6671 goto OTHER;
6673 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6674 is called by the code that handles resizing
6675 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6677 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6678 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6679 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6680 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6681 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6682 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6683 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6685 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6686 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6687 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6689 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6690 #endif
6692 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6693 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6695 #ifdef USE_GTK
6696 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6697 Only get real positions and check fullscreen when mapped. */
6698 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6699 && GTK_WIDGET_MAPPED (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6700 #endif
6702 /* What we have now is the position of Emacs's own window.
6703 Convert that to the position of the window manager window. */
6704 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6706 x_check_expected_move (f);
6707 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_WAIT)
6708 f->want_fullscreen &= ~(FULLSCREEN_WAIT|FULLSCREEN_BOTH);
6711 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6712 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6713 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6714 #endif
6716 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
6718 /* Since the WM decorations come below top_pos now,
6719 we must put them below top_pos in the future. */
6720 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
6721 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
6724 goto OTHER;
6726 case ButtonRelease:
6727 case ButtonPress:
6729 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6730 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6731 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6733 bzero (&compose_status, sizeof (compose_status));
6735 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6736 && last_mouse_frame
6737 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6738 f = last_mouse_frame;
6739 else
6740 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6742 if (f)
6744 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6745 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6746 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6748 Lisp_Object window;
6749 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6750 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6752 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 0, 0, 1);
6753 if (EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window))
6755 if (event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress)
6756 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 1, 0);
6757 else
6758 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y, 0,
6759 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6760 event.xbutton.state));
6761 tool_bar_p = 1;
6765 if (!tool_bar_p)
6766 if (!dpyinfo->x_focus_frame
6767 || f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
6769 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6770 if (! popup_activated ())
6771 #endif
6772 construct_mouse_click (&inev, &event, f);
6775 else
6777 struct scroll_bar *bar
6778 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6779 event.xbutton.window);
6781 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6782 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6783 scroll bars. */
6784 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6786 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6787 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6789 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6790 if (bar)
6791 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev);
6792 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6795 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6797 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6798 last_mouse_frame = f;
6799 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened
6800 before this event; any subsequent mouse-movement
6801 Emacs events should reflect only motion after
6802 the ButtonPress. */
6803 if (f != 0)
6804 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6806 if (!tool_bar_p)
6807 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6809 else
6810 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6812 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6813 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6814 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6815 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6816 Instead, save it away
6817 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6818 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6819 if (
6820 #ifdef USE_GTK
6821 ! popup_activated ()
6823 #endif
6824 f && event.type == ButtonPress
6825 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6826 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6827 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6828 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6829 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6830 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
6831 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
6833 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6834 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
6835 #ifdef USE_GTK
6836 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6837 #endif
6839 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6841 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
6842 goto OTHER;
6845 #ifdef USE_MOTIF /* This should do not harm for Lucid,
6846 but I am trying to be cautious. */
6847 else if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6849 if (!NILP (last_mouse_press_frame))
6851 f = XFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame);
6852 if (f->output_data.x)
6853 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
6855 else
6856 goto OTHER;
6858 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
6859 else
6860 goto OTHER;
6861 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
6863 break;
6865 case CirculateNotify:
6866 goto OTHER;
6868 case CirculateRequest:
6869 goto OTHER;
6871 case VisibilityNotify:
6872 goto OTHER;
6874 case MappingNotify:
6875 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
6876 local cache. */
6877 switch (event.xmapping.request)
6879 case MappingModifier:
6880 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
6881 /* This is meant to fall through. */
6882 case MappingKeyboard:
6883 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
6885 goto OTHER;
6887 default:
6888 OTHER:
6889 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6890 BLOCK_INPUT;
6891 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
6892 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
6893 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
6894 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6895 break;
6898 done:
6899 if (inev.kind != NO_EVENT)
6901 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
6902 count++;
6905 if (do_help
6906 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
6908 Lisp_Object frame;
6910 if (f)
6911 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
6912 else
6913 frame = Qnil;
6915 if (do_help > 0)
6917 any_help_event_p = 1;
6918 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
6919 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
6921 else
6923 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6924 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
6926 count++;
6929 *eventp = event;
6930 return count;
6934 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
6935 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
6936 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
6938 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
6940 x_dispatch_event (event, display)
6941 XEvent *event;
6942 Display *display;
6944 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6945 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
6947 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
6949 if (dpyinfo)
6950 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
6952 return finish;
6956 /* Read events coming from the X server.
6957 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler.
6958 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
6960 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
6961 thus pretending to be `read'.
6963 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
6965 static int
6966 XTread_socket (sd, expected, hold_quit)
6967 register int sd;
6968 int expected;
6969 struct input_event *hold_quit;
6971 int count = 0;
6972 XEvent event;
6973 int event_found = 0;
6974 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
6976 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
6978 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
6979 return -1;
6982 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
6983 BLOCK_INPUT;
6985 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
6986 input_signal_count++;
6988 ++handling_signal;
6990 /* Find the display we are supposed to read input for.
6991 It's the one communicating on descriptor SD. */
6992 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
6994 #if 0 /* This ought to be unnecessary; let's verify it. */
6995 #ifdef FIOSNBIO
6996 /* If available, Xlib uses FIOSNBIO to make the socket
6997 non-blocking, and then looks for EWOULDBLOCK. If O_NDELAY is set,
6998 FIOSNBIO is ignored, and instead of signaling EWOULDBLOCK,
6999 a read returns 0, which Xlib interprets as equivalent to EPIPE. */
7000 fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_SETFL, 0);
7001 #endif /* ! defined (FIOSNBIO) */
7002 #endif
7004 #if 0 /* This code can't be made to work, with multiple displays,
7005 and appears not to be used on any system any more.
7006 Also keyboard.c doesn't turn O_NDELAY on and off
7007 for X connections. */
7008 #ifndef SIGIO
7009 #ifndef HAVE_SELECT
7010 if (! (fcntl (dpyinfo->connection, F_GETFL, 0) & O_NDELAY))
7012 extern int read_alarm_should_throw;
7013 read_alarm_should_throw = 1;
7014 XPeekEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7015 read_alarm_should_throw = 0;
7017 #endif /* HAVE_SELECT */
7018 #endif /* SIGIO */
7019 #endif
7021 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7022 if (dpyinfo == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7024 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7025 x_io_error_quitter (dpyinfo->display);
7028 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
7030 struct input_event inev;
7031 BLOCK_INPUT;
7032 /* We don't need to EVENT_INIT (inev) here, as
7033 x_session_check_input copies an entire input_event. */
7034 if (x_session_check_input (&inev))
7036 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev, hold_quit);
7037 count++;
7039 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7041 #endif
7043 #ifndef USE_GTK
7044 while (XPending (dpyinfo->display))
7046 int finish;
7048 XNextEvent (dpyinfo->display, &event);
7050 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7051 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7052 if (x_filter_event (dpyinfo, &event))
7053 break;
7054 #endif
7055 event_found = 1;
7057 count += handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7059 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7060 goto out;
7062 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
7065 #ifdef USE_GTK
7067 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7068 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7069 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7070 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7072 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7073 from all displays. */
7075 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7077 current_count = count;
7078 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7080 gtk_main_iteration ();
7082 count = current_count;
7083 current_count = -1;
7084 current_hold_quit = 0;
7086 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7087 break;
7089 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7091 out:;
7093 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7094 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7095 if (! event_found)
7097 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7098 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7099 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7100 x_noop_count++;
7101 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7103 x_noop_count=0;
7105 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7106 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7108 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7110 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7111 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7115 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7116 raise it now. */
7117 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7118 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7120 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7121 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7124 --handling_signal;
7125 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7127 return count;
7133 /***********************************************************************
7134 Text Cursor
7135 ***********************************************************************/
7137 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7138 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7140 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7141 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7142 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7144 static void
7145 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc)
7146 struct window *w;
7147 struct glyph_row *row;
7148 GC gc;
7150 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7151 XRectangle clip_rect;
7152 int window_y, window_width;
7154 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7156 clip_rect.x = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, 0);
7157 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, row->y);
7158 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7159 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7160 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7162 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7166 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7168 static void
7169 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, row)
7170 struct window *w;
7171 struct glyph_row *row;
7173 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7174 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7175 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7176 int x, y, wd, h;
7177 XGCValues xgcv;
7178 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7179 GC gc;
7181 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7182 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7183 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7184 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7185 return;
7187 /* Compute the width of the rectangle to draw. If on a stretch
7188 glyph, and `x-stretch-block-cursor' is nil, don't draw a
7189 rectangle as wide as the glyph, but use a canonical character
7190 width instead. */
7191 wd = cursor_glyph->pixel_width - 1;
7192 if (cursor_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH
7193 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
7194 wd = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f), wd);
7195 w->phys_cursor_width = wd;
7197 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates from window-relative
7198 coordinates. */
7199 x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7200 y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y);
7202 /* Compute the proper height and ascent of the rectangle, based
7203 on the actual glyph. Using the full height of the row looks
7204 bad when there are tall images on that row. */
7205 h = max (FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f), cursor_glyph->ascent + cursor_glyph->descent);
7206 if (h < row->height)
7207 y += row->ascent /* - w->phys_cursor_ascent */ + cursor_glyph->descent - h;
7208 h--;
7210 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7211 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7212 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7213 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7214 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7215 else
7216 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7217 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7218 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7220 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7221 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7222 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h);
7223 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7227 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7229 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7230 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7231 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7232 --gerd. */
7234 static void
7235 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, row, width, kind)
7236 struct window *w;
7237 struct glyph_row *row;
7238 int width;
7239 enum text_cursor_kinds kind;
7241 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7242 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7244 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7245 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7246 and mini-buffer. */
7247 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7248 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7249 return;
7251 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7252 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7253 the bar might not be in the window. */
7254 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7256 struct glyph_row *row;
7257 row = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7258 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7260 else
7262 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7263 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7264 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7265 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7266 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7267 XGCValues xgcv;
7269 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7270 the bar cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7271 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7272 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7273 that the glyph is legible. */
7274 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7275 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7276 else
7277 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7278 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7280 if (gc)
7281 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7282 else
7284 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7285 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7288 if (width < 0)
7289 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7290 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7292 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7293 x_clip_to_row (w, row, gc);
7295 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7296 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7297 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7298 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7299 width, row->height);
7300 else
7301 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7302 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7303 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7304 row->height - width),
7305 cursor_glyph->pixel_width,
7306 width);
7308 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7313 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7315 static void
7316 x_define_frame_cursor (f, cursor)
7317 struct frame *f;
7318 Cursor cursor;
7320 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7324 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7326 static void
7327 x_clear_frame_area (f, x, y, width, height)
7328 struct frame *f;
7329 int x, y, width, height;
7331 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7332 x, y, width, height, False);
7336 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7338 static void
7339 x_draw_window_cursor (w, glyph_row, x, y, cursor_type, cursor_width, on_p, active_p)
7340 struct window *w;
7341 struct glyph_row *glyph_row;
7342 int x, y;
7343 int cursor_type, cursor_width;
7344 int on_p, active_p;
7346 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7348 if (on_p)
7350 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7351 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7353 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7354 && w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])
7356 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7357 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, 0);
7359 else
7360 switch (cursor_type)
7362 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7363 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7364 break;
7366 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7367 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7368 break;
7370 case BAR_CURSOR:
7371 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7372 break;
7374 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7375 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7376 break;
7378 case NO_CURSOR:
7379 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7380 break;
7382 default:
7383 abort ();
7386 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7387 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7388 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7389 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7390 #endif
7393 #ifndef XFlush
7394 if (updating_frame != f)
7395 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7396 #endif
7400 /* Icons. */
7402 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7405 x_bitmap_icon (f, file)
7406 struct frame *f;
7407 Lisp_Object file;
7409 int bitmap_id;
7411 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7412 return 1;
7414 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7415 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7416 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7417 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7419 if (STRINGP (file))
7421 #ifdef USE_GTK
7422 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7423 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7424 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7425 return 0;
7426 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7427 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7428 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7430 else
7432 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7433 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7435 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id
7436 = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, gnu_bits,
7437 gnu_width, gnu_height);
7438 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7441 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7442 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7443 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7444 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7445 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7447 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7450 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7451 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7453 return 0;
7457 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7458 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7461 x_text_icon (f, icon_name)
7462 struct frame *f;
7463 char *icon_name;
7465 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7466 return 1;
7468 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
7470 XTextProperty text;
7471 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7472 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7473 text.format = 8;
7474 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7475 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7477 #else /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7478 XSetIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), icon_name);
7479 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R4 */
7481 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7482 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7483 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7484 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7486 return 0;
7489 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7491 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7492 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string. */
7494 static Lisp_Object x_error_message_string;
7496 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7497 x_error_message_string. This is called from x_error_handler if
7498 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7500 static void
7501 x_error_catcher (display, error)
7502 Display *display;
7503 XErrorEvent *error;
7505 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code,
7506 SDATA (x_error_message_string),
7507 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7510 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7511 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7512 operating on.
7514 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7515 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7516 stored in x_error_message_string.
7518 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7519 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7521 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7523 void x_check_errors ();
7524 static Lisp_Object x_catch_errors_unwind ();
7527 x_catch_errors (dpy)
7528 Display *dpy;
7530 int count = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7532 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7533 XSync (dpy, False);
7535 record_unwind_protect (x_catch_errors_unwind,
7536 Fcons (make_save_value (dpy, 0),
7537 x_error_message_string));
7539 x_error_message_string = make_uninit_string (X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7540 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7542 return count;
7545 /* Unbind the binding that we made to check for X errors. */
7547 static Lisp_Object
7548 x_catch_errors_unwind (old_val)
7549 Lisp_Object old_val;
7551 Lisp_Object first;
7553 first = XCAR (old_val);
7555 XSync (XSAVE_VALUE (first)->pointer, False);
7557 x_error_message_string = XCDR (old_val);
7558 return Qnil;
7561 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7562 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7563 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7565 void
7566 x_check_errors (dpy, format)
7567 Display *dpy;
7568 char *format;
7570 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7571 XSync (dpy, False);
7573 if (SREF (x_error_message_string, 0))
7574 error (format, SDATA (x_error_message_string));
7577 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7578 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7581 x_had_errors_p (dpy)
7582 Display *dpy;
7584 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7585 XSync (dpy, False);
7587 return SREF (x_error_message_string, 0) != 0;
7590 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7592 void
7593 x_clear_errors (dpy)
7594 Display *dpy;
7596 SSET (x_error_message_string, 0, 0);
7599 /* Stop catching X protocol errors and let them make Emacs die.
7600 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors.
7601 COUNT should be the value that was returned by
7602 the corresponding call to x_catch_errors. */
7604 void
7605 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count)
7606 Display *dpy;
7607 int count;
7609 unbind_to (count, Qnil);
7612 #if 0
7613 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7614 x_trace_wire ()
7616 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7618 #endif /* ! 0 */
7621 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7622 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7623 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7624 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7625 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7627 static SIGTYPE
7628 x_connection_signal (signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7629 int signalnum; /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7631 #ifdef USG
7632 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7633 must reestablish each time */
7634 signal (signalnum, x_connection_signal);
7635 #endif /* USG */
7639 /************************************************************************
7640 Handling X errors
7641 ************************************************************************/
7643 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7645 static char *error_msg;
7647 /* Function installed as fatal_error_signal_hook in
7648 x_connection_closed. Print the X error message, and exit normally,
7649 instead of dumping core when XtCloseDisplay fails. */
7651 static void
7652 x_fatal_error_signal ()
7654 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7655 exit (70);
7658 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7659 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7661 static SIGTYPE
7662 x_connection_closed (dpy, error_message)
7663 Display *dpy;
7664 char *error_message;
7666 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7667 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7668 int count;
7670 error_msg = (char *) alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7671 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7672 handling_signal = 0;
7674 /* Prevent being called recursively because of an error condition
7675 below. Otherwise, we might end up with printing ``can't find per
7676 display information'' in the recursive call instead of printing
7677 the original message here. */
7678 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
7680 /* We have to close the display to inform Xt that it doesn't
7681 exist anymore. If we don't, Xt will continue to wait for
7682 events from the display. As a consequence, a sequence of
7684 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7685 ...kill the new frame, so that we get an IO error...
7686 M-x make-frame-on-display RET :1 RET
7688 will indefinitely wait in Xt for events for display `:1', opened
7689 in the first class to make-frame-on-display.
7691 Closing the display is reported to lead to a bus error on
7692 OpenWindows in certain situations. I suspect that is a bug
7693 in OpenWindows. I don't know how to cicumvent it here. */
7695 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7696 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display
7697 in the first place, so don't try to close it. */
7698 if (dpyinfo)
7700 extern void (*fatal_error_signal_hook) P_ ((void));
7701 fatal_error_signal_hook = x_fatal_error_signal;
7702 XtCloseDisplay (dpy);
7703 fatal_error_signal_hook = NULL;
7705 #endif
7707 #ifdef USE_GTK
7708 if (dpyinfo)
7709 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
7710 #endif
7712 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7713 if (dpyinfo)
7714 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7716 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7717 that are on the dead display. */
7718 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7720 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7721 minibuf_frame
7722 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7723 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7724 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7725 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7726 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7727 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7730 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7731 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7732 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7733 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7734 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7735 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7737 /* Set this to t so that Fdelete_frame won't get confused
7738 trying to find a replacement. */
7739 FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame))->Vdefault_minibuffer_frame = Qt;
7740 Fdelete_frame (frame, Qt);
7743 if (dpyinfo)
7744 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
7746 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
7748 if (x_display_list == 0)
7750 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7751 shut_down_emacs (0, 0, Qnil);
7752 exit (70);
7755 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7756 #ifdef SIGIO
7757 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGIO));
7758 #endif
7759 sigunblock (sigmask (SIGALRM));
7760 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7762 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7763 error ("%s", error_msg);
7767 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7768 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7769 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7771 static void
7772 x_error_quitter (display, error)
7773 Display *display;
7774 XErrorEvent *error;
7776 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7778 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7779 original error handler. */
7781 XGetErrorText (display, error->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7782 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7783 buf, error->request_code);
7784 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7788 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7789 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7791 static int
7792 x_error_handler (display, error)
7793 Display *display;
7794 XErrorEvent *error;
7796 if (! NILP (x_error_message_string))
7797 x_error_catcher (display, error);
7798 else
7799 x_error_quitter (display, error);
7800 return 0;
7803 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7804 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7805 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7807 static int
7808 x_io_error_quitter (display)
7809 Display *display;
7811 char buf[256];
7813 sprintf (buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'", DisplayString (display));
7814 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7815 return 0;
7818 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7820 /* Give frame F the font named FONTNAME as its default font, and
7821 return the full name of that font. FONTNAME may be a wildcard
7822 pattern; in that case, we choose some font that fits the pattern.
7823 The return value shows which font we chose. */
7825 Lisp_Object
7826 x_new_font (f, fontname)
7827 struct frame *f;
7828 register char *fontname;
7830 struct font_info *fontp
7831 = FS_LOAD_FONT (f, 0, fontname, -1);
7833 if (!fontp)
7834 return Qnil;
7836 FRAME_FONT (f) = (XFontStruct *) (fontp->font);
7837 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = fontp->baseline_offset;
7838 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = -1;
7840 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = FONT_WIDTH (FRAME_FONT (f));
7841 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (FRAME_FONT (f));
7843 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7845 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
7846 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
7848 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7849 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
7850 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
7852 else
7854 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
7855 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
7858 /* Now make the frame display the given font. */
7859 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
7861 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
7862 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7863 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->reverse_gc,
7864 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7865 XSetFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->cursor_gc,
7866 FRAME_FONT (f)->fid);
7868 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
7869 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
7870 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
7871 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
7872 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
7875 return build_string (fontp->full_name);
7878 /* Give frame F the fontset named FONTSETNAME as its default font, and
7879 return the full name of that fontset. FONTSETNAME may be a wildcard
7880 pattern; in that case, we choose some fontset that fits the pattern.
7881 The return value shows which fontset we chose. */
7883 Lisp_Object
7884 x_new_fontset (f, fontsetname)
7885 struct frame *f;
7886 char *fontsetname;
7888 int fontset = fs_query_fontset (build_string (fontsetname), 0);
7889 Lisp_Object result;
7891 if (fontset < 0)
7892 return Qnil;
7894 if (FRAME_FONTSET (f) == fontset)
7895 /* This fontset is already set in frame F. There's nothing more
7896 to do. */
7897 return fontset_name (fontset);
7899 result = x_new_font (f, (SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset))));
7901 if (!STRINGP (result))
7902 /* Can't load ASCII font. */
7903 return Qnil;
7905 /* Since x_new_font doesn't update any fontset information, do it now. */
7906 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7908 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7909 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
7910 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
7911 xic_set_xfontset (f, SDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
7912 #endif
7914 return build_string (fontsetname);
7918 /***********************************************************************
7919 X Input Methods
7920 ***********************************************************************/
7922 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7924 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7926 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
7927 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
7928 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
7930 static void
7931 xim_destroy_callback (xim, client_data, call_data)
7932 XIM xim;
7933 XPointer client_data;
7934 XPointer call_data;
7936 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
7937 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7939 BLOCK_INPUT;
7941 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
7942 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7944 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
7945 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
7947 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
7948 if (FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f))
7950 XFreeFontSet (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f));
7951 FRAME_XIC_FONTSET (f) = NULL;
7956 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
7957 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
7958 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
7959 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7962 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
7964 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7965 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
7966 extern char *XSetIMValues P_ ((XIM, ...));
7967 #endif
7969 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
7970 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
7972 static void
7973 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name)
7974 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7975 char *resource_name;
7977 XIM xim;
7979 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
7980 if (use_xim)
7982 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
7983 EMACS_CLASS);
7984 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
7986 if (xim)
7988 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7989 XIMCallback destroy;
7990 #endif
7992 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
7993 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
7995 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
7996 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
7997 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
7998 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
7999 #endif
8003 else
8004 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8005 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8009 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8011 struct xim_inst_t
8013 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8014 char *resource_name;
8017 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8018 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8019 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8020 when the callback was registered. */
8022 static void
8023 xim_instantiate_callback (display, client_data, call_data)
8024 Display *display;
8025 XPointer client_data;
8026 XPointer call_data;
8028 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8029 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8031 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8032 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8033 return;
8035 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8037 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8038 as they have no XIC. */
8039 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8041 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8043 BLOCK_INPUT;
8044 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8046 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8048 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8049 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8051 create_frame_xic (f);
8052 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8053 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8054 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8056 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8057 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8062 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8066 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8069 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8070 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8071 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8072 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8074 static void
8075 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name)
8076 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8077 char *resource_name;
8079 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8080 if (use_xim)
8082 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8083 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst;
8084 int len;
8086 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8087 xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct xim_inst_t));
8088 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8089 len = strlen (resource_name);
8090 xim_inst->resource_name = (char *) xmalloc (len + 1);
8091 bcopy (resource_name, xim_inst->resource_name, len + 1);
8092 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8093 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
8094 xim_instantiate_callback,
8095 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8096 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8097 least, hence the configure test. */
8098 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8099 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8100 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8101 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8102 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8105 else
8106 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8107 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8111 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8113 static void
8114 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo)
8115 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
8117 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8118 if (use_xim)
8120 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8121 if (dpyinfo->display)
8122 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8123 NULL, EMACS_CLASS,
8124 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8125 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8126 if (dpyinfo->display)
8127 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8128 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8129 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8131 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8134 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8138 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8139 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8141 void
8142 x_calc_absolute_position (f)
8143 struct frame *f;
8145 Window child;
8146 int win_x = 0, win_y = 0;
8147 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8149 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8150 is already for the top-left corner. */
8151 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8152 return;
8154 /* Find the offsets of the outside upper-left corner of
8155 the inner window, with respect to the outer window.
8156 But do this only if we will need the results. */
8157 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8158 /* This is to get *_pixels_outer_diff. */
8159 x_real_positions (f, &win_x, &win_y);
8161 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8162 position that fits on the screen. */
8163 if (flags & XNegative)
8164 f->left_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width
8165 - 2 * FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->x_pixels_outer_diff
8166 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
8167 + f->left_pos);
8170 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8172 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8173 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8174 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8176 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8177 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8178 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8179 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8180 is right, though.
8182 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8183 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8185 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8186 #endif
8188 if (flags & YNegative)
8189 f->top_pos = (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height
8190 - FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->y_pixels_outer_diff
8192 /* Assume the window manager decorations are the same size on
8193 three sides, i.e. left, right and bottom. This is to
8194 compensate for the bottom part. */
8195 - FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->x_pixels_outer_diff
8196 - height
8197 + f->top_pos);
8200 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8201 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8202 so the flags should correspond. */
8203 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8206 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8207 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8208 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8209 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8210 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8212 void
8213 x_set_offset (f, xoff, yoff, change_gravity)
8214 struct frame *f;
8215 register int xoff, yoff;
8216 int change_gravity;
8218 int modified_top, modified_left;
8220 if (change_gravity > 0)
8222 f->top_pos = yoff;
8223 f->left_pos = xoff;
8224 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8225 if (xoff < 0)
8226 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8227 if (yoff < 0)
8228 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8229 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8231 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8233 BLOCK_INPUT;
8234 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8236 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8237 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8239 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8241 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8242 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8243 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8244 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8245 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8248 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8249 modified_left, modified_top);
8251 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
8252 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8254 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 1;
8255 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top = f->top_pos;
8256 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left = f->left_pos;
8259 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8262 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8263 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8264 static void
8265 x_check_fullscreen (f)
8266 struct frame *f;
8268 if (f->want_fullscreen & FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8270 int width, height, ign;
8272 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
8274 x_fullscreen_adjust (f, &width, &height, &ign, &ign);
8276 /* We do not need to move the window, it shall be taken care of
8277 when setting WM manager hints.
8278 If the frame is visible already, the position is checked by
8279 x_check_expected_move. */
8280 if (FRAME_COLS (f) != width || FRAME_LINES (f) != height)
8282 change_frame_size (f, height, width, 0, 1, 0);
8283 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8284 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8286 /* Wait for the change of frame size to occur */
8287 f->want_fullscreen |= FULLSCREEN_WAIT;
8292 /* If frame parameters are set after the frame is mapped, we need to move
8293 the window.
8294 Some window managers moves the window to the right position, some
8295 moves the outer window manager window to the specified position.
8296 Here we check that we are in the right spot. If not, make a second
8297 move, assuming we are dealing with the second kind of window manager. */
8298 static void
8299 x_check_expected_move (f)
8300 struct frame *f;
8302 if (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move)
8304 int expect_top = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_top;
8305 int expect_left = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->expected_left;
8307 if (expect_top != f->top_pos || expect_left != f->left_pos)
8309 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8310 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expect_left - f->left_pos;
8311 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expect_top - f->top_pos;
8313 x_set_offset (f, expect_left, expect_top, 1);
8315 else if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN)
8316 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8318 /* Just do this once */
8319 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->check_expected_move = 0;
8324 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8325 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8326 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8327 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8329 static void
8330 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8331 struct frame *f;
8332 int change_gravity;
8333 int cols, rows;
8335 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8337 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8338 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8339 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8341 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0
8342 ? FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f)
8343 : (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f)));
8345 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8347 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols);
8348 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows);
8350 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8351 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8353 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8354 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8355 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8357 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8358 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8359 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8360 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8362 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8363 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8364 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8365 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8366 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8368 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8369 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8370 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8371 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8372 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8374 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8375 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8376 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8377 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8378 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8380 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8384 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8385 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8386 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8387 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8389 void
8390 x_set_window_size (f, change_gravity, cols, rows)
8391 struct frame *f;
8392 int change_gravity;
8393 int cols, rows;
8395 BLOCK_INPUT;
8397 #ifdef USE_GTK
8398 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8399 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8400 else
8401 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8402 #elif USE_X_TOOLKIT
8404 if (f->output_data.x->widget != NULL)
8406 /* The x and y position of the widget is clobbered by the
8407 call to XtSetValues within EmacsFrameSetCharSize.
8408 This is a real kludge, but I don't understand Xt so I can't
8409 figure out a correct fix. Can anyone else tell me? -- rms. */
8410 int xpos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.x;
8411 int ypos = f->output_data.x->widget->core.y;
8412 EmacsFrameSetCharSize (f->output_data.x->edit_widget, cols, rows);
8413 f->output_data.x->widget->core.x = xpos;
8414 f->output_data.x->widget->core.y = ypos;
8416 else
8417 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8419 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8421 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8423 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8425 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8426 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8428 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8429 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8430 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8431 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8432 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8434 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8437 /* Mouse warping. */
8439 void
8440 x_set_mouse_position (f, x, y)
8441 struct frame *f;
8442 int x, y;
8444 int pix_x, pix_y;
8446 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8447 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8449 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8450 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8452 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8453 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8455 BLOCK_INPUT;
8457 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8458 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8459 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8462 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8464 void
8465 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (f, pix_x, pix_y)
8466 struct frame *f;
8467 int pix_x, pix_y;
8469 BLOCK_INPUT;
8471 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8472 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8473 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8476 /* focus shifting, raising and lowering. */
8478 void
8479 x_focus_on_frame (f)
8480 struct frame *f;
8482 #if 0 /* This proves to be unpleasant. */
8483 x_raise_frame (f);
8484 #endif
8485 #if 0
8486 /* I don't think that the ICCCM allows programs to do things like this
8487 without the interaction of the window manager. Whatever you end up
8488 doing with this code, do it to x_unfocus_frame too. */
8489 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8490 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8491 #endif /* ! 0 */
8494 void
8495 x_unfocus_frame (f)
8496 struct frame *f;
8498 #if 0
8499 /* Look at the remarks in x_focus_on_frame. */
8500 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_focus_frame == f)
8501 XSetInputFocus (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), PointerRoot,
8502 RevertToPointerRoot, CurrentTime);
8503 #endif /* ! 0 */
8506 /* Raise frame F. */
8508 void
8509 x_raise_frame (f)
8510 struct frame *f;
8512 if (f->async_visible)
8514 BLOCK_INPUT;
8515 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8516 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8517 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8521 /* Lower frame F. */
8523 void
8524 x_lower_frame (f)
8525 struct frame *f;
8527 if (f->async_visible)
8529 BLOCK_INPUT;
8530 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
8531 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8532 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8536 static void
8537 XTframe_raise_lower (f, raise_flag)
8538 FRAME_PTR f;
8539 int raise_flag;
8541 if (raise_flag)
8542 x_raise_frame (f);
8543 else
8544 x_lower_frame (f);
8547 /* Change of visibility. */
8549 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
8550 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
8551 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
8552 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
8553 but it will become visible later when the window manager
8554 finishes with it. */
8556 void
8557 x_make_frame_visible (f)
8558 struct frame *f;
8560 Lisp_Object type;
8561 int original_top, original_left;
8562 int retry_count = 2;
8564 retry:
8566 BLOCK_INPUT;
8568 type = x_icon_type (f);
8569 if (!NILP (type))
8570 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8572 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8574 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
8575 call x_set_offset a second time
8576 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
8577 before the window gets really visible. */
8578 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8579 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
8580 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8582 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
8584 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8585 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
8586 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8587 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8588 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8589 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8590 #ifdef USE_GTK
8591 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8592 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8593 #else
8594 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8595 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8596 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8597 #if 0 /* This seems to bring back scroll bars in the wrong places
8598 if the window configuration has changed. They seem
8599 to come back ok without this. */
8600 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
8601 XMapSubwindows (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8602 #endif
8605 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8607 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
8608 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
8609 so that incoming events are handled. */
8611 Lisp_Object frame;
8612 int count;
8613 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
8614 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
8615 will set it when they are handled. */
8616 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
8618 original_left = f->left_pos;
8619 original_top = f->top_pos;
8621 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
8622 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8624 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
8626 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
8627 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
8628 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
8629 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
8631 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
8632 because the window manager may choose the position
8633 and we don't want to override it. */
8635 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
8636 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
8637 && previously_visible)
8639 Drawable rootw;
8640 int x, y;
8641 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
8643 BLOCK_INPUT;
8645 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
8646 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
8647 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
8648 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
8649 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
8650 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
8651 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
8652 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8653 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
8655 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
8656 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8657 original_left, original_top);
8659 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8662 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8664 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
8665 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
8666 MapNotify at all.. */
8667 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
8668 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
8670 /* Force processing of queued events. */
8671 x_sync (f);
8673 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
8674 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
8675 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
8676 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
8677 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
8678 probably a bug. */
8679 if (input_polling_used ())
8681 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
8682 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
8683 handler reset it. */
8684 extern void poll_for_input_1 P_ ((void));
8685 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
8686 poll_suppress_count = 1;
8687 poll_for_input_1 ();
8688 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
8691 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
8692 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8695 /* 2000-09-28: In
8697 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
8698 (iconify-frame f)
8699 (raise-frame f))
8701 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
8702 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
8703 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
8704 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
8706 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count > 0)
8707 goto retry;
8711 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
8713 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
8715 void
8716 x_make_frame_invisible (f)
8717 struct frame *f;
8719 Window window;
8721 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
8722 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
8724 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8725 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8726 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8728 #if 0/* This might add unreliability; I don't trust it -- rms. */
8729 if (! f->async_visible && ! f->async_iconified)
8730 return;
8731 #endif
8733 BLOCK_INPUT;
8735 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
8736 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
8737 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
8738 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
8739 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
8740 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
8742 #ifdef USE_GTK
8743 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8744 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8745 else
8746 #endif
8748 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
8750 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
8751 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
8753 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8754 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
8756 #else /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8758 /* Tell the window manager what we're going to do. */
8759 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8761 XEvent unmap;
8763 unmap.xunmap.type = UnmapNotify;
8764 unmap.xunmap.window = window;
8765 unmap.xunmap.event = DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8766 unmap.xunmap.from_configure = False;
8767 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8768 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8769 False,
8770 SubstructureRedirectMaskSubstructureNotifyMask,
8771 &unmap))
8773 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8774 error ("Can't notify window manager of withdrawal");
8778 /* Unmap the window ourselves. Cheeky! */
8779 XUnmapWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window);
8780 #endif /* ! defined (HAVE_X11R4) */
8783 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
8784 just by the event that we get from the server.
8785 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
8786 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
8787 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
8788 f->visible = 0;
8789 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
8790 f->async_visible = 0;
8791 f->async_iconified = 0;
8793 x_sync (f);
8795 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8798 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
8800 void
8801 x_iconify_frame (f)
8802 struct frame *f;
8804 int result;
8805 Lisp_Object type;
8807 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
8808 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
8809 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
8811 if (f->async_iconified)
8812 return;
8814 BLOCK_INPUT;
8816 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
8818 type = x_icon_type (f);
8819 if (!NILP (type))
8820 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
8822 #ifdef USE_GTK
8823 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8825 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8826 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8828 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
8829 f->iconified = 1;
8830 f->visible = 1;
8831 f->async_iconified = 1;
8832 f->async_visible = 0;
8833 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8834 return;
8836 #endif
8838 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8840 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8842 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
8843 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8844 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
8845 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8846 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
8847 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
8848 so we have to record it here. */
8849 f->iconified = 1;
8850 f->visible = 1;
8851 f->async_iconified = 1;
8852 f->async_visible = 0;
8853 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8854 return;
8857 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8858 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
8859 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
8860 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8862 if (!result)
8863 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8865 f->async_iconified = 1;
8866 f->async_visible = 0;
8869 BLOCK_INPUT;
8870 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8871 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8872 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8874 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
8875 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
8876 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && !FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
8877 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
8879 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
8880 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
8882 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
8883 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
8885 XEvent message;
8887 message.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
8888 message.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
8889 message.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
8890 message.xclient.format = 32;
8891 message.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
8893 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
8894 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
8895 False,
8896 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
8897 &message))
8899 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
8900 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
8904 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
8905 IconicState. */
8906 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
8908 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
8910 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
8911 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8914 f->async_iconified = 1;
8915 f->async_visible = 0;
8917 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8918 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8919 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8923 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
8925 void
8926 x_free_frame_resources (f)
8927 struct frame *f;
8929 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8930 Lisp_Object bar;
8931 struct scroll_bar *b;
8933 BLOCK_INPUT;
8935 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
8936 commands to the X server. */
8937 if (dpyinfo->display)
8939 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
8940 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
8942 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8943 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
8944 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
8945 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
8946 toolkit scroll bars. */
8947 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
8949 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
8950 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
8952 #endif
8954 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8955 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
8956 free_frame_xic (f);
8957 #endif
8959 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8960 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
8962 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
8963 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
8965 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
8966 we are using a toolkit. */
8967 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8968 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8970 free_frame_menubar (f);
8971 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8973 #ifdef USE_GTK
8974 /* In the GTK version, tooltips are normal X
8975 frames. We must check and free both types. */
8976 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
8978 gtk_widget_destroy (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
8979 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) = 0; /* Set to avoid XDestroyWindow below */
8980 FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f) = 0;
8982 #endif /* USE_GTK */
8984 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
8985 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
8986 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
8988 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->foreground_pixel);
8989 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->background_pixel);
8990 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
8991 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
8992 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
8993 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
8995 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
8996 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
8997 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
8998 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
8999 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9000 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9001 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9002 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9003 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9004 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9005 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9006 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9007 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9008 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9009 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9011 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9012 free_frame_faces (f);
9014 x_free_gcs (f);
9015 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9018 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event)
9019 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9021 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9022 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9024 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9025 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9026 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9027 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9028 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9029 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9031 if (f == dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9033 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9034 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9035 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9036 = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9037 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9038 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9039 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9042 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9046 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9048 void
9049 x_destroy_window (f)
9050 struct frame *f;
9052 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9054 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9055 commands to the X server. */
9056 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9057 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9059 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9063 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9065 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9066 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9067 that the window now has.
9068 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9069 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9070 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9072 #ifndef USE_GTK
9073 void
9074 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, flags, user_position)
9075 struct frame *f;
9076 long flags;
9077 int user_position;
9079 XSizeHints size_hints;
9081 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9082 Arg al[2];
9083 int ac = 0;
9084 Dimension widget_width, widget_height;
9085 #endif
9087 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9089 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9090 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9092 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9093 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9095 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9096 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNwidth, &widget_width); ac++;
9097 XtSetArg (al[ac], XtNheight, &widget_height); ac++;
9098 XtGetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, ac);
9099 size_hints.height = widget_height;
9100 size_hints.width = widget_width;
9101 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9102 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9103 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9104 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9106 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9107 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9108 size_hints.max_width
9109 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->width - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9110 size_hints.max_height
9111 = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->height - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9113 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes.
9115 (When we use the X toolkit, we don't do it here.
9116 Instead we copy the values that the widgets are using, below.) */
9117 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9119 int base_width, base_height;
9120 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9122 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9123 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9125 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9127 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9128 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9129 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9130 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9131 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9133 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9134 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9135 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9137 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9138 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9139 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9140 size_hints.base_height = base_height;
9141 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9142 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9143 #else
9144 size_hints.min_width = base_width;
9145 size_hints.min_height = base_height;
9146 #endif
9149 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9150 if (flags)
9152 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9153 goto no_read;
9155 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9158 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9159 long supplied_return;
9160 int value;
9162 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9163 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9164 &supplied_return);
9165 #else
9166 value = XGetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints);
9167 #endif
9169 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9170 size_hints.base_height = hints.base_height;
9171 size_hints.base_width = hints.base_width;
9172 size_hints.min_height = hints.min_height;
9173 size_hints.min_width = hints.min_width;
9174 #endif
9176 if (flags)
9177 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9178 else
9180 if (value == 0)
9181 hints.flags = 0;
9182 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9183 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9184 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9185 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9186 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9187 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9188 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9189 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9193 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9194 no_read:
9195 #endif
9197 #ifdef PWinGravity
9198 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9199 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9201 if (user_position)
9203 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9204 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9206 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9208 #ifdef HAVE_X11R4
9209 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9210 #else
9211 XSetNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9212 #endif
9214 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9216 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9218 void
9219 x_wm_set_window_state (f, state)
9220 struct frame *f;
9221 int state;
9223 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9224 Arg al[1];
9226 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9227 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9228 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9229 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9231 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9232 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9234 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9235 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9238 void
9239 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, pixmap_id)
9240 struct frame *f;
9241 int pixmap_id;
9243 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9245 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9246 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9247 #endif
9249 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9251 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9252 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9253 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9254 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9256 else
9258 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon pixmap.
9259 The following line does it, only if no icon has yet been created,
9260 for some window managers. But with mwm it crashes.
9261 Some people say it should clear the IconPixmapHint bit in this case,
9262 but that doesn't work, and the X consortium said it isn't the
9263 right thing at all. Since there is no way to win,
9264 best to explicitly give up. */
9265 #if 0
9266 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = None;
9267 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = None;
9268 #else
9269 return;
9270 #endif
9273 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9276 Arg al[1];
9277 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9278 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9279 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9280 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9283 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9285 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9286 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9288 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9291 void
9292 x_wm_set_icon_position (f, icon_x, icon_y)
9293 struct frame *f;
9294 int icon_x, icon_y;
9296 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9298 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9299 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9300 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9302 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9306 /***********************************************************************
9307 Fonts
9308 ***********************************************************************/
9310 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of font FONT_IDX of frame F. */
9312 struct font_info *
9313 x_get_font_info (f, font_idx)
9314 FRAME_PTR f;
9315 int font_idx;
9317 return (FRAME_X_FONT_TABLE (f) + font_idx);
9321 /* Return a list of names of available fonts matching PATTERN on frame F.
9323 If SIZE is > 0, it is the size (maximum bounds width) of fonts
9324 to be listed.
9326 SIZE < 0 means include scalable fonts.
9328 Frame F null means we have not yet created any frame on X, and
9329 consult the first display in x_display_list. MAXNAMES sets a limit
9330 on how many fonts to match. */
9332 Lisp_Object
9333 x_list_fonts (f, pattern, size, maxnames)
9334 struct frame *f;
9335 Lisp_Object pattern;
9336 int size;
9337 int maxnames;
9339 Lisp_Object list = Qnil, patterns, newlist = Qnil, key = Qnil;
9340 Lisp_Object tem, second_best;
9341 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo
9342 = f ? FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) : x_display_list;
9343 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
9344 int try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9345 int count;
9346 int allow_auto_scaled_font = 0;
9348 if (size < 0)
9350 allow_auto_scaled_font = 1;
9351 size = 0;
9354 patterns = Fassoc (pattern, Valternate_fontname_alist);
9355 if (NILP (patterns))
9356 patterns = Fcons (pattern, Qnil);
9358 if (maxnames == 1 && !size)
9359 /* We can return any single font matching PATTERN. */
9360 try_XLoadQueryFont = 1;
9362 for (; CONSP (patterns); patterns = XCDR (patterns))
9364 int num_fonts;
9365 char **names = NULL;
9367 pattern = XCAR (patterns);
9368 /* See if we cached the result for this particular query.
9369 The cache is an alist of the form:
9370 ((((PATTERN . MAXNAMES) . SCALABLE) (FONTNAME . WIDTH) ...) ...) */
9371 tem = XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element);
9372 key = Fcons (Fcons (pattern, make_number (maxnames)),
9373 allow_auto_scaled_font ? Qt : Qnil);
9374 list = Fassoc (key, tem);
9375 if (!NILP (list))
9377 list = Fcdr_safe (list);
9378 /* We have a cashed list. Don't have to get the list again. */
9379 goto label_cached;
9382 /* At first, put PATTERN in the cache. */
9384 BLOCK_INPUT;
9385 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9387 if (try_XLoadQueryFont)
9389 XFontStruct *font;
9390 unsigned long value;
9392 font = XLoadQueryFont (dpy, SDATA (pattern));
9393 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9395 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9396 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9397 font = NULL;
9398 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9401 if (font
9402 && XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9404 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (dpy, (Atom) value);
9405 int len = strlen (name);
9406 char *tmp;
9408 /* If DXPC (a Differential X Protocol Compressor)
9409 Ver.3.7 is running, XGetAtomName will return null
9410 string. We must avoid such a name. */
9411 if (len == 0)
9412 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9413 else
9415 num_fonts = 1;
9416 names = (char **) alloca (sizeof (char *));
9417 /* Some systems only allow alloca assigned to a
9418 simple var. */
9419 tmp = (char *) alloca (len + 1); names[0] = tmp;
9420 bcopy (name, names[0], len + 1);
9421 XFree (name);
9424 else
9425 try_XLoadQueryFont = 0;
9427 if (font)
9428 XFreeFont (dpy, font);
9431 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9433 /* We try at least 10 fonts because XListFonts will return
9434 auto-scaled fonts at the head. */
9435 if (maxnames < 0)
9437 int limit;
9439 for (limit = 500;;)
9441 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), limit, &num_fonts);
9442 if (num_fonts == limit)
9444 BLOCK_INPUT;
9445 XFreeFontNames (names);
9446 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9447 limit *= 2;
9449 else
9450 break;
9453 else
9454 names = XListFonts (dpy, SDATA (pattern), max (maxnames, 10),
9455 &num_fonts);
9457 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9459 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9460 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9461 names = NULL;
9462 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9466 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9467 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9469 if (names)
9471 int i;
9473 /* Make a list of all the fonts we got back.
9474 Store that in the font cache for the display. */
9475 for (i = 0; i < num_fonts; i++)
9477 int width = 0;
9478 char *p = names[i];
9479 int average_width = -1, resx = 0, dashes = 0;
9481 /* Count the number of dashes in NAMES[I]. If there are
9482 14 dashes, the field value following 9th dash
9483 (RESOLUTION_X) is nonzero, and the field value
9484 following 12th dash (AVERAGE_WIDTH) is 0, this is a
9485 auto-scaled font which is usually too ugly to be used
9486 for editing. Let's ignore it. */
9487 while (*p)
9488 if (*p++ == '-')
9490 dashes++;
9491 if (dashes == 7) /* PIXEL_SIZE field */
9492 width = atoi (p);
9493 else if (dashes == 9)
9494 resx = atoi (p);
9495 else if (dashes == 12) /* AVERAGE_WIDTH field */
9496 average_width = atoi (p);
9499 if (allow_auto_scaled_font
9500 || dashes < 14 || average_width != 0 || resx == 0)
9502 tem = build_string (names[i]);
9503 if (NILP (Fassoc (tem, list)))
9505 if (STRINGP (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp)
9506 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case
9507 (Vx_pixel_size_width_font_regexp, names[i]))
9508 >= 0))
9509 /* We can set the value of PIXEL_SIZE to the
9510 width of this font. */
9511 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, make_number (width)), list);
9512 else
9513 /* For the moment, width is not known. */
9514 list = Fcons (Fcons (tem, Qnil), list);
9519 if (!try_XLoadQueryFont)
9521 BLOCK_INPUT;
9522 XFreeFontNames (names);
9523 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9527 /* Now store the result in the cache. */
9528 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9529 Fcons (Fcons (key, list), XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9531 label_cached:
9532 if (NILP (list)) continue; /* Try the remaining alternatives. */
9534 newlist = second_best = Qnil;
9535 /* Make a list of the fonts that have the right width. */
9536 for (; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9538 int found_size;
9540 tem = XCAR (list);
9542 if (!CONSP (tem) || NILP (XCAR (tem)))
9543 continue;
9544 if (!size)
9546 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9547 continue;
9550 if (!INTEGERP (XCDR (tem)))
9552 /* Since we have not yet known the size of this font, we
9553 must try slow function call XLoadQueryFont. */
9554 XFontStruct *thisinfo;
9556 BLOCK_INPUT;
9557 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
9558 thisinfo = XLoadQueryFont (dpy,
9559 SDATA (XCAR (tem)));
9560 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
9562 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9563 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9564 thisinfo = NULL;
9565 x_clear_errors (dpy);
9567 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
9568 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9570 if (thisinfo)
9572 XSETCDR (tem,
9573 (thisinfo->min_bounds.width == 0
9574 ? make_number (0)
9575 : make_number (thisinfo->max_bounds.width)));
9576 BLOCK_INPUT;
9577 XFreeFont (dpy, thisinfo);
9578 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9580 else
9581 /* For unknown reason, the previous call of XListFont had
9582 returned a font which can't be opened. Record the size
9583 as 0 not to try to open it again. */
9584 XSETCDR (tem, make_number (0));
9587 found_size = XINT (XCDR (tem));
9588 if (found_size == size)
9589 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (tem), newlist);
9590 else if (found_size > 0)
9592 if (NILP (second_best))
9593 second_best = tem;
9594 else if (found_size < size)
9596 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9597 || XINT (XCDR (second_best)) < found_size)
9598 second_best = tem;
9600 else
9602 if (XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > size
9603 && XINT (XCDR (second_best)) > found_size)
9604 second_best = tem;
9608 if (!NILP (newlist))
9609 break;
9610 else if (!NILP (second_best))
9612 newlist = Fcons (XCAR (second_best), Qnil);
9613 break;
9617 return newlist;
9621 #if GLYPH_DEBUG
9623 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9624 font table. */
9626 static void
9627 x_check_font (f, font)
9628 struct frame *f;
9629 XFontStruct *font;
9631 int i;
9632 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9634 xassert (font != NULL);
9636 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9637 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9638 && font == dpyinfo->font_table[i].font)
9639 break;
9641 xassert (i < dpyinfo->n_fonts);
9644 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG != 0 */
9646 /* Set *W to the minimum width, *H to the minimum font height of FONT.
9647 Note: There are (broken) X fonts out there with invalid XFontStruct
9648 min_bounds contents. For example, handa@etl.go.jp reports that
9649 "-adobe-courier-medium-r-normal--*-180-*-*-m-*-iso8859-1" fonts
9650 have font->min_bounds.width == 0. */
9652 static INLINE void
9653 x_font_min_bounds (font, w, h)
9654 XFontStruct *font;
9655 int *w, *h;
9657 *h = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9658 *w = font->min_bounds.width;
9660 /* Try to handle the case where FONT->min_bounds has invalid
9661 contents. Since the only font known to have invalid min_bounds
9662 is fixed-width, use max_bounds if min_bounds seems to be invalid. */
9663 if (*w <= 0)
9664 *w = font->max_bounds.width;
9668 /* Compute the smallest character width and smallest font height over
9669 all fonts available on frame F. Set the members smallest_char_width
9670 and smallest_font_height in F's x_display_info structure to
9671 the values computed. Value is non-zero if smallest_font_height or
9672 smallest_char_width become smaller than they were before. */
9674 static int
9675 x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f)
9676 struct frame *f;
9678 int i;
9679 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9680 XFontStruct *font;
9681 int old_width = dpyinfo->smallest_char_width;
9682 int old_height = dpyinfo->smallest_font_height;
9684 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = 100000;
9685 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = 100000;
9687 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9688 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
9690 struct font_info *fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9691 int w, h;
9693 font = (XFontStruct *) fontp->font;
9694 xassert (font != (XFontStruct *) ~0);
9695 x_font_min_bounds (font, &w, &h);
9697 dpyinfo->smallest_font_height = min (dpyinfo->smallest_font_height, h);
9698 dpyinfo->smallest_char_width = min (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width, w);
9701 xassert (dpyinfo->smallest_char_width > 0
9702 && dpyinfo->smallest_font_height > 0);
9704 return (dpyinfo->n_fonts == 1
9705 || dpyinfo->smallest_char_width < old_width
9706 || dpyinfo->smallest_font_height < old_height);
9710 /* Load font named FONTNAME of the size SIZE for frame F, and return a
9711 pointer to the structure font_info while allocating it dynamically.
9712 If SIZE is 0, load any size of font.
9713 If loading is failed, return NULL. */
9715 struct font_info *
9716 x_load_font (f, fontname, size)
9717 struct frame *f;
9718 register char *fontname;
9719 int size;
9721 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9722 Lisp_Object font_names;
9723 int count;
9725 /* Get a list of all the fonts that match this name. Once we
9726 have a list of matching fonts, we compare them against the fonts
9727 we already have by comparing names. */
9728 font_names = x_list_fonts (f, build_string (fontname), size, 1);
9730 if (!NILP (font_names))
9732 Lisp_Object tail;
9733 int i;
9735 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9736 for (tail = font_names; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
9737 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9738 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name,
9739 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))
9740 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name,
9741 SDATA (XCAR (tail)))))
9742 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9745 /* Load the font and add it to the table. */
9747 char *full_name;
9748 XFontStruct *font;
9749 struct font_info *fontp;
9750 unsigned long value;
9751 int i;
9753 /* If we have found fonts by x_list_font, load one of them. If
9754 not, we still try to load a font by the name given as FONTNAME
9755 because XListFonts (called in x_list_font) of some X server has
9756 a bug of not finding a font even if the font surely exists and
9757 is loadable by XLoadQueryFont. */
9758 if (size > 0 && !NILP (font_names))
9759 fontname = (char *) SDATA (XCAR (font_names));
9761 BLOCK_INPUT;
9762 count = x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9763 font = (XFontStruct *) XLoadQueryFont (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), fontname);
9764 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)))
9766 /* This error is perhaps due to insufficient memory on X
9767 server. Let's just ignore it. */
9768 font = NULL;
9769 x_clear_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9771 x_uncatch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), count);
9772 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9773 if (!font)
9774 return NULL;
9776 /* Find a free slot in the font table. */
9777 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; ++i)
9778 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name == NULL)
9779 break;
9781 /* If no free slot found, maybe enlarge the font table. */
9782 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts
9783 && dpyinfo->n_fonts == dpyinfo->font_table_size)
9785 int sz;
9786 dpyinfo->font_table_size = max (16, 2 * dpyinfo->font_table_size);
9787 sz = dpyinfo->font_table_size * sizeof *dpyinfo->font_table;
9788 dpyinfo->font_table
9789 = (struct font_info *) xrealloc (dpyinfo->font_table, sz);
9792 fontp = dpyinfo->font_table + i;
9793 if (i == dpyinfo->n_fonts)
9794 ++dpyinfo->n_fonts;
9796 /* Now fill in the slots of *FONTP. */
9797 BLOCK_INPUT;
9798 bzero (fontp, sizeof (*fontp));
9799 fontp->font = font;
9800 fontp->font_idx = i;
9801 fontp->name = (char *) xmalloc (strlen (fontname) + 1);
9802 bcopy (fontname, fontp->name, strlen (fontname) + 1);
9804 /* Try to get the full name of FONT. Put it in FULL_NAME. */
9805 full_name = 0;
9806 if (XGetFontProperty (font, XA_FONT, &value))
9808 char *name = (char *) XGetAtomName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), (Atom) value);
9809 char *p = name;
9810 int dashes = 0;
9812 /* Count the number of dashes in the "full name".
9813 If it is too few, this isn't really the font's full name,
9814 so don't use it.
9815 In X11R4, the fonts did not come with their canonical names
9816 stored in them. */
9817 while (*p)
9819 if (*p == '-')
9820 dashes++;
9821 p++;
9824 if (dashes >= 13)
9826 full_name = (char *) xmalloc (p - name + 1);
9827 bcopy (name, full_name, p - name + 1);
9830 XFree (name);
9833 if (full_name != 0)
9834 fontp->full_name = full_name;
9835 else
9836 fontp->full_name = fontp->name;
9838 fontp->size = font->max_bounds.width;
9839 fontp->height = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
9841 if (NILP (font_names))
9843 /* We come here because of a bug of XListFonts mentioned at
9844 the head of this block. Let's store this information in
9845 the cache for x_list_fonts. */
9846 Lisp_Object lispy_name = build_string (fontname);
9847 Lisp_Object lispy_full_name = build_string (fontp->full_name);
9848 Lisp_Object key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_name, make_number (256)),
9849 Qnil);
9851 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9852 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9853 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9854 make_number (fontp->size)),
9855 Qnil)),
9856 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9857 if (full_name)
9859 key = Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name, make_number (256)),
9860 Qnil);
9861 XSETCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element,
9862 Fcons (Fcons (key,
9863 Fcons (Fcons (lispy_full_name,
9864 make_number (fontp->size)),
9865 Qnil)),
9866 XCDR (dpyinfo->name_list_element)));
9870 /* The slot `encoding' specifies how to map a character
9871 code-points (0x20..0x7F or 0x2020..0x7F7F) of each charset to
9872 the font code-points (0:0x20..0x7F, 1:0xA0..0xFF), or
9873 (0:0x2020..0x7F7F, 1:0xA0A0..0xFFFF, 3:0x20A0..0x7FFF,
9874 2:0xA020..0xFF7F). For the moment, we don't know which charset
9875 uses this font. So, we set information in fontp->encoding[1]
9876 which is never used by any charset. If mapping can't be
9877 decided, set FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED. */
9878 fontp->encoding[1]
9879 = (font->max_byte1 == 0
9880 /* 1-byte font */
9881 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9882 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9883 ? 0 /* 0x20..0x7F */
9884 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20..0xFF */
9885 : 1) /* 0xA0..0xFF */
9886 /* 2-byte font */
9887 : (font->min_byte1 < 0x80
9888 ? (font->max_byte1 < 0x80
9889 ? (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9890 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9891 ? 0 /* 0x2020..0x7F7F */
9892 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x2020..0x7FFF */
9893 : 3) /* 0x20A0..0x7FFF */
9894 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0x20??..0xA0?? */
9895 : (font->min_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9896 ? (font->max_char_or_byte2 < 0x80
9897 ? 2 /* 0xA020..0xFF7F */
9898 : FONT_ENCODING_NOT_DECIDED) /* 0xA020..0xFFFF */
9899 : 1))); /* 0xA0A0..0xFFFF */
9901 fontp->baseline_offset
9902 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET, &value)
9903 ? (long) value : 0);
9904 fontp->relative_compose
9905 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE, &value)
9906 ? (long) value : 0);
9907 fontp->default_ascent
9908 = (XGetFontProperty (font, dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT, &value)
9909 ? (long) value : 0);
9911 /* Set global flag fonts_changed_p to non-zero if the font loaded
9912 has a character with a smaller width than any other character
9913 before, or if the font loaded has a smaller height than any
9914 other font loaded before. If this happens, it will make a
9915 glyph matrix reallocation necessary. */
9916 fonts_changed_p |= x_compute_min_glyph_bounds (f);
9917 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9918 return fontp;
9923 /* Return a pointer to struct font_info of a font named FONTNAME for
9924 frame F. If no such font is loaded, return NULL. */
9926 struct font_info *
9927 x_query_font (f, fontname)
9928 struct frame *f;
9929 register char *fontname;
9931 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9932 int i;
9934 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
9935 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name
9936 && (!strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name, fontname)
9937 || !strcmp (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name, fontname)))
9938 return (dpyinfo->font_table + i);
9939 return NULL;
9943 /* Find a CCL program for a font specified by FONTP, and set the member
9944 `encoder' of the structure. */
9946 void
9947 x_find_ccl_program (fontp)
9948 struct font_info *fontp;
9950 Lisp_Object list, elt;
9952 elt = Qnil;
9953 for (list = Vfont_ccl_encoder_alist; CONSP (list); list = XCDR (list))
9955 elt = XCAR (list);
9956 if (CONSP (elt)
9957 && STRINGP (XCAR (elt))
9958 && ((fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->name)
9959 >= 0)
9960 || (fast_c_string_match_ignore_case (XCAR (elt), fontp->full_name)
9961 >= 0)))
9962 break;
9965 if (! NILP (list))
9967 struct ccl_program *ccl
9968 = (struct ccl_program *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct ccl_program));
9970 if (setup_ccl_program (ccl, XCDR (elt)) < 0)
9971 xfree (ccl);
9972 else
9973 fontp->font_encoder = ccl;
9979 /***********************************************************************
9980 Initialization
9981 ***********************************************************************/
9983 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9984 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9985 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9986 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9988 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9989 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9990 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9992 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9993 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9994 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9995 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9996 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9997 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9998 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
10000 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10002 static int x_initialized;
10004 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10005 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
10006 the screen number from the server number. */
10007 static int
10008 same_x_server (name1, name2)
10009 const char *name1, *name2;
10011 int seen_colon = 0;
10012 const unsigned char *system_name = SDATA (Vsystem_name);
10013 int system_name_length = strlen (system_name);
10014 int length_until_period = 0;
10016 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
10017 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
10018 length_until_period++;
10020 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
10021 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
10022 name1 += 4;
10023 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
10024 name2 += 4;
10025 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
10026 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
10027 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
10028 name1 += system_name_length;
10029 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
10030 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
10031 name2 += system_name_length;
10032 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
10033 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
10034 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
10035 name1 += length_until_period;
10036 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
10037 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
10038 name2 += length_until_period;
10040 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
10042 if (*name1 == ':')
10043 seen_colon++;
10044 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
10045 return 1;
10047 return (seen_colon
10048 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
10049 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
10051 #endif
10053 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
10054 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
10055 to 5. */
10056 static void
10057 get_bits_and_offset (mask, bits, offset)
10058 unsigned long mask;
10059 int *bits;
10060 int *offset;
10062 int nr = 0;
10063 int off = 0;
10065 while (!(mask & 1))
10067 off++;
10068 mask >>= 1;
10071 while (mask & 1)
10073 nr++;
10074 mask >>= 1;
10077 *offset = off;
10078 *bits = nr;
10081 struct x_display_info *
10082 x_term_init (display_name, xrm_option, resource_name)
10083 Lisp_Object display_name;
10084 char *xrm_option;
10085 char *resource_name;
10087 int connection;
10088 Display *dpy;
10089 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10090 XrmDatabase xrdb;
10092 BLOCK_INPUT;
10094 if (!x_initialized)
10096 x_initialize ();
10097 ++x_initialized;
10100 #ifdef USE_GTK
10102 #define NUM_ARGV 10
10103 int argc;
10104 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
10105 char **argv2 = argv;
10106 GdkAtom atom;
10108 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
10110 /* Opening another display. If xg_display_open returns less
10111 than zero, we are probably on GTK 2.0, which can only handle
10112 one display. GTK 2.2 or later can handle more than one. */
10113 if (xg_display_open (SDATA (display_name), &dpy) < 0)
10114 error ("Sorry, this version of GTK can only handle one display");
10116 else
10118 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
10119 argv[argc] = 0;
10121 argc = 0;
10122 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
10124 if (! NILP (display_name))
10126 argv[argc++] = "--display";
10127 argv[argc++] = SDATA (display_name);
10130 argv[argc++] = "--name";
10131 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
10133 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10134 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10135 #endif
10137 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10139 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10140 fixup_locale ();
10141 xg_initialize ();
10143 dpy = GDK_DISPLAY ();
10145 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function */
10146 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10148 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10150 struct gcpro gcpro1, gcpro2;
10151 char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10152 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10154 GCPRO2 (s, abs_file);
10155 s = make_string (file, strlen (file));
10156 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10158 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10159 gtk_rc_parse (SDATA (abs_file));
10161 UNGCPRO;
10164 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10165 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10168 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10169 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10170 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10171 errors with X11R5:
10172 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10173 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10174 So let's not use it until R6. */
10175 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10176 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10177 #endif
10180 int argc = 0;
10181 char *argv[3];
10183 argv[0] = "";
10184 argc = 1;
10185 if (xrm_option)
10187 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10188 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10190 turn_on_atimers (0);
10191 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SDATA (display_name),
10192 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10193 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10194 &argc, argv);
10195 turn_on_atimers (1);
10197 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10198 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10199 fixup_locale ();
10200 #endif
10203 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10204 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5
10205 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10206 #endif
10207 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SDATA (display_name));
10208 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10209 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10211 /* Detect failure. */
10212 if (dpy == 0)
10214 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10215 return 0;
10218 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10220 dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) xmalloc (sizeof (struct x_display_info));
10221 bzero (dpyinfo, sizeof *dpyinfo);
10223 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10225 struct x_display_info *share;
10226 Lisp_Object tail;
10228 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10229 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10230 if (same_x_server (SDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10231 SDATA (display_name)))
10232 break;
10233 if (share)
10234 dpyinfo->kboard = share->kboard;
10235 else
10237 dpyinfo->kboard = (KBOARD *) xmalloc (sizeof (KBOARD));
10238 init_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10239 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10241 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10242 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10243 dpyinfo->kboard->Vsystem_key_alist
10244 = call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10245 build_string (vendor ? vendor : ""));
10246 BLOCK_INPUT;
10249 dpyinfo->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10250 all_kboards = dpyinfo->kboard;
10251 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10252 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10253 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10254 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10255 current_kboard = dpyinfo->kboard;
10257 dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count++;
10259 #endif
10261 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10262 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10263 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10265 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10266 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10267 x_display_name_list);
10268 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10270 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10272 #if 0
10273 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10274 #endif /* ! 0 */
10276 dpyinfo->x_id_name
10277 = (char *) xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10278 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name)
10279 + 2);
10280 sprintf (dpyinfo->x_id_name, "%s@%s",
10281 SDATA (Vinvocation_name), SDATA (Vsystem_name));
10283 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10284 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10286 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10287 #ifdef USE_GTK
10288 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10289 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10290 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10292 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10293 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10295 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10296 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10297 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10298 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10299 #else
10300 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10301 #endif
10302 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10303 all versions. */
10304 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10306 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10307 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10308 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10309 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10310 dpyinfo->height = HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10311 dpyinfo->width = WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10312 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10313 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10314 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10315 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10316 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10317 dpyinfo->font_table = NULL;
10318 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10319 dpyinfo->font_table_size = 0;
10320 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10321 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10322 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10323 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10324 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10325 dpyinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10326 dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10327 dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_row = dpyinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10328 dpyinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10329 dpyinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10330 dpyinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10331 dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = dpyinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10332 dpyinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10333 dpyinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10334 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10335 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10336 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10337 dpyinfo->image_cache = make_image_cache ();
10338 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10340 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10341 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10342 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10344 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10346 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10347 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10348 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10349 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10350 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10351 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10354 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10355 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10357 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10359 Lisp_Object value;
10360 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10361 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10362 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10363 Qnil, Qnil);
10364 if (STRINGP (value)
10365 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10366 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10367 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10370 else
10371 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10372 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10375 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10376 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10377 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10378 dpyinfo->resy = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10379 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10380 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10381 dpyinfo->resx = pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10384 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
10385 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_PROTOCOLS", False);
10386 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus
10387 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", False);
10388 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself
10389 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", False);
10390 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window
10391 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", False);
10392 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state
10393 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CHANGE_STATE", False);
10394 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied
10395 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", False);
10396 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved
10397 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_MOVED", False);
10398 dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader
10399 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", False);
10400 dpyinfo->Xatom_editres
10401 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "Editres", False);
10402 dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD
10403 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "CLIPBOARD", False);
10404 dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP
10405 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TIMESTAMP", False);
10406 dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT
10407 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TEXT", False);
10408 dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT
10409 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "COMPOUND_TEXT", False);
10410 dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING
10411 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "UTF8_STRING", False);
10412 dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE
10413 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DELETE", False);
10414 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE
10415 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "MULTIPLE", False);
10416 dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR
10417 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "INCR", False);
10418 dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP
10419 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_EMACS_TMP_", False);
10420 dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS
10421 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "TARGETS", False);
10422 dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL
10423 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "NULL", False);
10424 dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR
10425 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "ATOM_PAIR", False);
10426 /* For properties of font. */
10427 dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE
10428 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PIXEL_SIZE", False);
10429 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET
10430 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", False);
10431 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE
10432 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", False);
10433 dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT
10434 = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", False);
10436 /* Ghostscript support. */
10437 dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "PAGE", False);
10438 dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "DONE", False);
10440 dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar = XInternAtom (dpyinfo->display, "SCROLLBAR",
10441 False);
10443 dpyinfo->cut_buffers_initialized = 0;
10445 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10446 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10449 char null_bits[1];
10451 null_bits[0] = 0x00;
10453 dpyinfo->null_pixel
10454 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10455 null_bits, 1, 1, (long) 0, (long) 0,
10460 extern int gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height;
10461 extern char *gray_bitmap_bits;
10462 dpyinfo->gray
10463 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10464 gray_bitmap_bits,
10465 gray_bitmap_width, gray_bitmap_height,
10466 (unsigned long) 1, (unsigned long) 0, 1);
10469 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10470 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10471 #endif
10473 #ifdef subprocesses
10474 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10475 if (connection != 0)
10476 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10477 #endif
10479 #ifndef F_SETOWN_BUG
10480 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10481 #ifdef F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG
10482 /* stdin is a socket here */
10483 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, -getpid ());
10484 #else /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10485 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10486 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN_SOCK_NEG) */
10487 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10488 #endif /* F_SETOWN_BUG */
10490 #ifdef SIGIO
10491 if (interrupt_input)
10492 init_sigio (connection);
10493 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10495 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10496 #ifdef HAVE_X11R5 /* It seems X11R4 lacks XtCvtStringToFont, and XPointer. */
10497 /* Make sure that we have a valid font for dialog boxes
10498 so that Xt does not crash. */
10500 Display *dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10501 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10502 Font font;
10503 int count;
10505 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10506 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10507 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10508 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10509 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10510 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10511 count = x_catch_errors (dpy);
10512 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10513 abort ();
10514 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10515 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10516 x_uncatch_errors (dpy, count);
10518 #endif
10519 #endif
10521 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10522 for debugging X code. */
10524 Lisp_Object value;
10525 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10526 build_string ("synchronous"),
10527 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10528 Qnil, Qnil);
10529 if (STRINGP (value)
10530 && (!strcmp (SDATA (value), "true")
10531 || !strcmp (SDATA (value), "on")))
10532 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10536 Lisp_Object value;
10537 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10538 build_string ("useXIM"),
10539 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10540 Qnil, Qnil);
10541 #ifdef USE_XIM
10542 if (STRINGP (value)
10543 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "false")
10544 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "off")))
10545 use_xim = 0;
10546 #else
10547 if (STRINGP (value)
10548 && (!strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "true")
10549 || !strcmp (XSTRING (value)->data, "on")))
10550 use_xim = 1;
10551 #endif
10554 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10555 /* Only do this for the first display. */
10556 if (x_initialized == 1)
10557 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10558 #endif
10560 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10562 return dpyinfo;
10565 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, assuming all frames are already gone,
10566 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10568 void
10569 x_delete_display (dpyinfo)
10570 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
10572 int i;
10574 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10576 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10577 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10578 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10579 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10580 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10581 else
10583 Lisp_Object tail;
10585 tail = x_display_name_list;
10586 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10588 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10590 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10591 break;
10593 tail = XCDR (tail);
10597 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10598 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10600 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10601 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10602 else
10604 struct x_display_info *tail;
10606 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10607 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10608 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10611 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT /* I'm told Xt does this itself. */
10612 #ifndef AIX /* On AIX, XCloseDisplay calls this. */
10613 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10614 #endif
10615 #endif
10616 #ifdef MULTI_KBOARD
10617 if (--dpyinfo->kboard->reference_count == 0)
10618 delete_kboard (dpyinfo->kboard);
10619 #endif
10620 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10621 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10622 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10623 #endif
10625 /* Free the font names in the font table. */
10626 for (i = 0; i < dpyinfo->n_fonts; i++)
10627 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name)
10629 if (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name != dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name)
10630 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].full_name);
10631 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table[i].name);
10634 if (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder)
10635 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table->font_encoder);
10637 xfree (dpyinfo->font_table);
10638 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10639 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10640 xfree (dpyinfo);
10643 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10645 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10646 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10647 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10648 that slows us down. */
10650 static void
10651 x_process_timeouts (timer)
10652 struct atimer *timer;
10654 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10656 BLOCK_INPUT;
10657 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10658 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10659 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10663 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10666 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10668 extern frame_parm_handler x_frame_parm_handlers[];
10670 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10672 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10673 x_produce_glyphs,
10674 x_write_glyphs,
10675 x_insert_glyphs,
10676 x_clear_end_of_line,
10677 x_scroll_run,
10678 x_after_update_window_line,
10679 x_update_window_begin,
10680 x_update_window_end,
10681 x_cursor_to,
10682 x_flush,
10683 #ifndef XFlush
10684 x_flush,
10685 #else
10686 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10687 #endif
10688 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10689 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10690 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10691 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10692 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10693 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10694 x_per_char_metric,
10695 x_encode_char,
10696 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10697 x_draw_glyph_string,
10698 x_define_frame_cursor,
10699 x_clear_frame_area,
10700 x_draw_window_cursor,
10701 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10702 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10705 void
10706 x_initialize ()
10708 rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10710 clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10711 ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10712 delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10713 ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10714 reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10715 set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10716 update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10717 update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10718 set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10719 read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10720 frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10721 mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10722 frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10723 frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10724 set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10725 condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10726 redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10727 judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10729 scroll_region_ok = 1; /* we'll scroll partial frames */
10730 char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10731 line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* we'll just blt 'em */
10732 fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well */
10733 memory_below_frame = 0; /* we don't remember what scrolls
10734 off the bottom */
10735 baud_rate = 19200;
10737 x_noop_count = 0;
10738 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10739 any_help_event_p = 0;
10741 #ifdef USE_GTK
10742 current_count = -1;
10743 #endif
10745 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10746 Fset_input_mode (Qt, Qnil, Qt, Qnil);
10748 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10749 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10751 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10753 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10754 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10755 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10756 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10757 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10758 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10759 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10761 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10763 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10764 every 0.1s. This is necessary because some widget sets use
10765 timeouts internally, for example the LessTif menu bar, or the
10766 Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timouts aren't processed, these
10767 widgets don't behave normally. */
10769 EMACS_TIME interval;
10770 EMACS_SET_SECS_USECS (interval, 0, 100000);
10771 start_atimer (ATIMER_CONTINUOUS, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10773 #endif
10775 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10776 #ifndef USE_GTK
10777 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10778 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10779 #endif
10780 #endif
10782 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10783 original error handler. */
10784 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10785 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10787 /* Disable Window Change signals; they are handled by X events. */
10788 #ifdef SIGWINCH
10789 signal (SIGWINCH, SIG_DFL);
10790 #endif /* SIGWINCH */
10792 signal (SIGPIPE, x_connection_signal);
10796 void
10797 syms_of_xterm ()
10799 staticpro (&x_error_message_string);
10800 x_error_message_string = Qnil;
10802 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10803 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10805 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10806 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10808 staticpro (&Qvendor_specific_keysyms);
10809 Qvendor_specific_keysyms = intern ("vendor-specific-keysyms");
10811 staticpro (&Qutf_8);
10812 Qutf_8 = intern ("utf-8");
10813 staticpro (&Qlatin_1);
10814 Qlatin_1 = intern ("latin-1");
10816 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10817 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10819 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10820 &x_use_underline_position_properties,
10821 doc: /* *Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10822 nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10823 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10824 to 4.1, set this to nil. */);
10825 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10827 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", &Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10828 doc: /* What X toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses.
10829 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use X toolkit scroll bars.
10830 Otherwise, value is a symbol describing the X toolkit. */);
10831 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10832 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10833 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("motif");
10834 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10835 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw3d");
10836 #elif USE_GTK
10837 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("gtk");
10838 #else
10839 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern ("xaw");
10840 #endif
10841 #else
10842 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10843 #endif
10845 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10846 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10848 Qmodifier_value = intern ("modifier-value");
10849 Qalt = intern ("alt");
10850 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10851 Qhyper = intern ("hyper");
10852 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10853 Qmeta = intern ("meta");
10854 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10855 Qsuper = intern ("super");
10856 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10858 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", &Vx_alt_keysym,
10859 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10860 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10861 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10862 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10863 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10865 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", &Vx_hyper_keysym,
10866 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10867 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10868 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10869 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10870 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10872 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", &Vx_meta_keysym,
10873 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10874 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10875 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10876 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10877 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10879 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", &Vx_super_keysym,
10880 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10881 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10882 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10883 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10884 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10886 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", &Vx_keysym_table,
10887 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10888 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10889 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10890 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10891 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10894 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */
10896 /* arch-tag: 6d4e4cb7-abc1-4302-9585-d84dcfb09d0f
10897 (do not change this comment) */